US20220033817A1 - Targeting Ligands - Google Patents

Targeting Ligands Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20220033817A1
US20220033817A1 US17/351,169 US202117351169A US2022033817A1 US 20220033817 A1 US20220033817 A1 US 20220033817A1 US 202117351169 A US202117351169 A US 202117351169A US 2022033817 A1 US2022033817 A1 US 2022033817A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
targeting ligand
expression
substituted
compound
linked
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Pending
Application number
US17/351,169
Inventor
Zhen Li
Tao Pei
Agnieszka Glebocka
Michael Lawler
Fred Fleitz
Erich Altenhofer
Pankaj Kumar
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals Inc
Original Assignee
Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals Inc filed Critical Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals Inc
Priority to US17/351,169 priority Critical patent/US20220033817A1/en
Assigned to Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. reassignment Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: GLEBOCKA, AGNIESZKA, LI, ZHEN, ALTENHOFER, Erich, LAWLER, Michael, FLEITZ, FRED, KUMAR, PANKAJ, PEI, TAO
Publication of US20220033817A1 publication Critical patent/US20220033817A1/en
Pending legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • A61K47/51Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
    • A61K47/54Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic compound
    • A61K47/549Sugars, nucleosides, nucleotides or nucleic acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7008Compounds having an amino group directly attached to a carbon atom of the saccharide radical, e.g. D-galactosamine, ranimustine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7088Compounds having three or more nucleosides or nucleotides
    • A61K31/7105Natural ribonucleic acids, i.e. containing only riboses attached to adenine, guanine, cytosine or uracil and having 3'-5' phosphodiester links
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7088Compounds having three or more nucleosides or nucleotides
    • A61K31/711Natural deoxyribonucleic acids, i.e. containing only 2'-deoxyriboses attached to adenine, guanine, cytosine or thymine and having 3'-5' phosphodiester links
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7088Compounds having three or more nucleosides or nucleotides
    • A61K31/713Double-stranded nucleic acids or oligonucleotides
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • A61K47/51Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
    • A61K47/54Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic compound
    • A61K47/555Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic compound pre-targeting systems involving an organic compound, other than a peptide, protein or antibody, for targeting specific cells
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K48/00Medicinal preparations containing genetic material which is inserted into cells of the living body to treat genetic diseases; Gene therapy
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K48/00Medicinal preparations containing genetic material which is inserted into cells of the living body to treat genetic diseases; Gene therapy
    • A61K48/0008Medicinal preparations containing genetic material which is inserted into cells of the living body to treat genetic diseases; Gene therapy characterised by an aspect of the 'non-active' part of the composition delivered, e.g. wherein such 'non-active' part is not delivered simultaneously with the 'active' part of the composition
    • A61K48/0025Medicinal preparations containing genetic material which is inserted into cells of the living body to treat genetic diseases; Gene therapy characterised by an aspect of the 'non-active' part of the composition delivered, e.g. wherein such 'non-active' part is not delivered simultaneously with the 'active' part of the composition wherein the non-active part clearly interacts with the delivered nucleic acid
    • A61K48/0033Medicinal preparations containing genetic material which is inserted into cells of the living body to treat genetic diseases; Gene therapy characterised by an aspect of the 'non-active' part of the composition delivered, e.g. wherein such 'non-active' part is not delivered simultaneously with the 'active' part of the composition wherein the non-active part clearly interacts with the delivered nucleic acid the non-active part being non-polymeric
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H21/00Compounds containing two or more mononucleotide units having separate phosphate or polyphosphate groups linked by saccharide radicals of nucleoside groups, e.g. nucleic acids
    • C07H21/02Compounds containing two or more mononucleotide units having separate phosphate or polyphosphate groups linked by saccharide radicals of nucleoside groups, e.g. nucleic acids with ribosyl as saccharide radical
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H21/00Compounds containing two or more mononucleotide units having separate phosphate or polyphosphate groups linked by saccharide radicals of nucleoside groups, e.g. nucleic acids
    • C07H21/04Compounds containing two or more mononucleotide units having separate phosphate or polyphosphate groups linked by saccharide radicals of nucleoside groups, e.g. nucleic acids with deoxyribosyl as saccharide radical
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H5/00Compounds containing saccharide radicals in which the hetero bonds to oxygen have been replaced by the same number of hetero bonds to halogen, nitrogen, sulfur, selenium, or tellurium
    • C07H5/04Compounds containing saccharide radicals in which the hetero bonds to oxygen have been replaced by the same number of hetero bonds to halogen, nitrogen, sulfur, selenium, or tellurium to nitrogen
    • C07H5/06Aminosugars
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/11DNA or RNA fragments; Modified forms thereof; Non-coding nucleic acids having a biological activity
    • C12N15/113Non-coding nucleic acids modulating the expression of genes, e.g. antisense oligonucleotides; Antisense DNA or RNA; Triplex- forming oligonucleotides; Catalytic nucleic acids, e.g. ribozymes; Nucleic acids used in co-suppression or gene silencing
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/10Type of nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/14Type of nucleic acid interfering N.A.
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/31Chemical structure of the backbone
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/31Chemical structure of the backbone
    • C12N2310/315Phosphorothioates
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/31Chemical structure of the backbone
    • C12N2310/317Chemical structure of the backbone with an inverted bond, e.g. a cap structure
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/32Chemical structure of the sugar
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/32Chemical structure of the sugar
    • C12N2310/3212'-O-R Modification
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/32Chemical structure of the sugar
    • C12N2310/3222'-R Modification
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/33Chemical structure of the base
    • C12N2310/332Abasic residue
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/35Nature of the modification
    • C12N2310/351Conjugate
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/35Nature of the modification
    • C12N2310/351Conjugate
    • C12N2310/3515Lipophilic moiety, e.g. cholesterol
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/35Nature of the modification
    • C12N2310/351Conjugate
    • C12N2310/3517Marker; Tag
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/35Nature of the modification
    • C12N2310/352Nature of the modification linked to the nucleic acid via a carbon atom
    • C12N2310/3521Methyl
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2310/00Structure or type of the nucleic acid
    • C12N2310/30Chemical structure
    • C12N2310/35Nature of the modification
    • C12N2310/353Nature of the modification linked to the nucleic acid via an atom other than carbon
    • C12N2310/3533Halogen
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N2320/00Applications; Uses
    • C12N2320/30Special therapeutic applications
    • C12N2320/32Special delivery means, e.g. tissue-specific

Definitions

  • One method to facilitate delivery of a compound, such as a therapeutic compound, to a desired location in vivo is by linking or attaching the compound to a targeting ligand.
  • oligomeric compounds that include nucleotide sequences at least partially complementary to a target nucleic acid have been shown to alter the function and activity of the target both in vitro and in vivo.
  • a target nucleic acid such as mRNA
  • oligomeric compounds When delivered to a cell containing a target nucleic acid (such as mRNA), oligomeric compounds have been shown to modulate the expression of the target resulting in altered transcription or translation of the target nucleic acid.
  • the oligomeric compound can reduce the expression of the gene by inhibiting the nucleic acid target and/or triggering the degradation of the target nucleic acid.
  • RNA interference is a biological process by which RNA or RNA-like molecules (such as chemically modified RNA molecules) are able to silence gene expression through degradation.
  • the process of post-transcriptional gene silencing is thought to be an evolutionarily-conserved cellular defense mechanism used to prevent the expression of foreign genes.
  • Synthetic RNA and RNA-like molecules have been shown to elicit RNA interference in vivo.
  • Elbashir et al. describes RNAi induced by introduction of duplexes of synthetic 21-nucleotide RNA molecules in cultured mammalian cells.
  • the types of synthetic RNA or RNA-like molecules that can trigger the RNAi response mechanism may be comprised of modified nucleotides and/or one or more non-phosphodiester linkages.
  • single-stranded RNA and RNA-like molecules which can also include modified nucleotides and have one or more non-phosphodiester linkages, can also alter the expression of a target nucleic acid, such as a target mRNA.
  • targeting ligands that can enhance the delivery of therapeutic compounds to a specific target site, e.g., a specific organ or tissue, within a subject such as a human patient or animal.
  • the targeting ligands described herein can enhance the targeted delivery of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds.
  • the targeting ligands can enhance the delivery of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds to the liver.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein include, consist of, or consist essentially of one or more targeting moieties, one or more tethers, one or more branch point groups, and one or more linkers.
  • Linkers suitable for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein include a “rigid” linker, which can impart sufficient stability and rigidity to the overall targeting ligand to reduce potential interaction between one or more of the targeting moiety(ies) and the therapeutic compound to which it is or they are linked. Additionally, the “rigid” linkers suitable for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein are useful in efficiently synthesizing the targeting ligands as phosphoramidite compounds (also referred to herein as “phosphoramidite-containing compounds”).
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein include, consist of, or consist essentially of one or more targeting moieties, one or more tethers, and one or more branch point groups with a linker replacement moiety.
  • the linker replacement moiety includes, consists of, or consists essentially of, one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl groups, or covalently linked combinations thereof, located within the branch point group. Having a linker replacement moiety within the branch point group confers properties similar to those of the “rigid” linkers disclosed herein, by providing sufficient stability and rigidity to the overall targeting ligand. Additionally, the branch point groups with linker replacement moieties suitable for use in the targeting ligands are useful in efficiently synthesizing the targeting ligands as phosphoramidite compounds.
  • targeting ligands comprising, consisting of, or consisting essentially of a structure of Formula I, as shown in FIG. 22 ,
  • n is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4), and wherein the linker is a structure selected from the group consisting of:
  • each Z′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure
  • n′′ is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4), and when present, each Z′′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl
  • V comprises one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl
  • the targeting ligands include a branch point group with a linker replacement moiety.
  • targeting ligands comprising, consisting of, or consisting essentially of a structure of Formula II, as shown in FIG. 23 ,
  • n is an integer between 1 and 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4), and wherein the linker replacement moiety includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobut
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein can be linked, directly or indirectly, to a compound, such as a therapeutic compound, e.g., an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, for example, to the 3′ or 5′ terminal end of the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound includes one or more modified nucleotides.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent, such as a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein are linked to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein are linked to the RNAi agent via a phosphate, phosphorothioate, or phosphonate group at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein include one or more targeting moieties.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein include N-acetyl-galactosamine as the targeting moiety.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein have structures represented by the following:
  • compositions including, consisting of, or consisting essentially of, a targeting ligand and an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • compositions including a targeting ligand and an RNAi agent.
  • compositions disclosed herein including a targeting ligand and an RNAi agent have the structure represented by:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1012a); or
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • phosphoramidite compounds including targeting ligands.
  • the phosphoramidite compounds including targeting ligands disclosed herein have the structure represented by:
  • compositions that include the targeting ligands disclosed herein.
  • a phosphoramidite compound including a targeting ligand comprising (i) covalently linking the linker to the branch point group, and (ii) linking the linker to a phosphorus atom of a phosphoramidite through a phosphytylation reaction with a phosphoramidite forming reagent, thereby forming a phosphoramidite compound.
  • the term “linked” when referring to the connection between two molecules means that two molecules are joined by a covalent bond or that two molecules are associated via noncovalent bonds (e.g., hydrogen bonds or ionic bonds).
  • the association between the two different molecules has a K D of less than 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 4 M (e.g., less than 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 5 M, less than 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 M, or less than 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 7 M) in physiologically acceptable buffer (e.g., phosphate buffered saline).
  • directly linked refers to a first compound or group being linked to a second compound or group without any intervening atoms or groups of atoms.
  • indirectly linked refers to a first compound being linked to a second compound or group through an intermediary group, compound, or molecule, such as, for example, a linking group.
  • linked includes both “directly linked” and “indirectly linked” as those terms are defined herein.
  • an “oligomeric compound” is a nucleotide sequence containing about 10-50 nucleotides or nucleotide base pairs.
  • an oligomeric compound has a nucleobase sequence that is at least partially complementary to a coding sequence in an expressed target nucleic acid or target gene within a cell.
  • the oligomeric compounds upon delivery to a cell expressing a gene, are able to inhibit the expression of the underlying gene, and are referred to herein as “expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds.” The gene expression can be inhibited in vitro or in vivo.
  • Oligonucleotides include, but are not limited to: oligonucleotides, single-stranded oligonucleotides, single-stranded antisense oligonucleotides, short interfering RNAs (siRNAs), double-strand RNAs (dsRNA), micro RNAs (miRNAs), short hairpin RNAs (shRNA), ribozymes, interfering RNA molecules, and dicer substrates.
  • siRNAs short interfering RNAs
  • dsRNA double-strand RNAs
  • miRNAs micro RNAs
  • shRNA short hairpin RNAs
  • ribozymes interfering RNA molecules, and dicer substrates.
  • oligonucleotide means a polymer of linked nucleosides each of which can be independently modified or unmodified.
  • single-stranded oligonucleotide means a single-stranded oligomeric compound having a sequence at least partially complementary to a target mRNA, that is capable of hybridizing to a target mRNA through hydrogen bonding under mammalian physiological conditions (or comparable conditions in vitro).
  • a single-stranded oligonucleotide is a single stranded antisense oligonucleotide.
  • RNAi agent means an agent that contains an RNA or RNA-like (e.g., chemically modified RNA) oligonucleotide molecule that is capable of degrading or inhibiting translation of messenger RNA (mRNA) transcripts of a target mRNA in a sequence specific manner.
  • RNAi agents may operate through the RNA interference mechanism (i.e., inducing RNA interference through interaction with the RNA interference pathway machinery (RNA-induced silencing complex or RISC) of mammalian cells), or by any alternative mechanism(s) or pathway(s).
  • RNAi agents While it is believed that RNAi agents, as that term is used herein, operate primarily through the RNA interference mechanism, the disclosed RNAi agents are not bound by or limited to any particular pathway or mechanism of action.
  • RNAi agents include, but are not limited to: single-stranded oligonucleotides, single-stranded antisense oligonucleotides, short interfering RNAs (siRNAs), double-strand RNAs (dsRNA), micro RNAs (miRNAs), short hairpin RNAs (shRNA), and dicer substrates.
  • the RNAi agents described herein are comprised of an oligonucleotide having a strand that is at least partially complementary to the mRNA being targeted.
  • RNAi agents described herein are double-stranded, and are comprised of an antisense strand and a sense strand that is at least partially complementary to the antisense strand.
  • RNAi agents may be comprised of modified nucleotides and/or one or more non-phosphodiester linkages.
  • the RNAi agents described herein are single-stranded.
  • the terms “silence,” “reduce,” “inhibit,” “down-regulate,” or “knockdown” when referring to expression of a given gene mean that the expression of the gene, as measured by the level of RNA transcribed from the gene or the level of polypeptide, protein or protein subunit translated from the mRNA in a cell, group of cells, tissue, organ, or subject in which the gene is transcribed, is reduced when the cell, group of cells, tissue, organ, or subject is treated with oligomeric compounds linked to the targeting ligands described herein as compared to a second cell, group of cells, tissue, organ, or subject that has not or have not been so treated.
  • sequence or “nucleotide sequence” mean a succession or order of nucleobases or nucleotides, described with a succession of letters using the standard nucleotide nomenclature.
  • the term “complementary,” when used to describe a first nucleotide sequence (e.g., RNAi agent sense strand or targeted mRNA) in relation to a second nucleotide sequence (e.g., single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide or a double-stranded RNAi agent antisense strand), means the ability of an oligonucleotide or polynucleotide including the first nucleotide sequence to hybridize (form base pair hydrogen bonds under mammalian physiological conditions (or comparable conditions in vitro)) and form a duplex or double helical structure under certain conditions with an oligonucleotide or polynucleotide including the second nucleotide sequence.
  • Complementary sequences include Watson-Crick base pairs or non-Watson-Crick base pairs and include natural or modified nucleotides or nucleotide mimics, at least to the extent that the above requirements with respect to the
  • perfect complementary or “fully complementary” means that all (100%) of the bases in a contiguous sequence of a first polynucleotide will hybridize with the same number of bases in a contiguous sequence of a second polynucleotide.
  • the contiguous sequence may comprise all or a part of a first or second nucleotide sequence.
  • partially complementary means that in a hybridized pair of nucleobase sequences, at least 70%, but not all, of the bases in a contiguous sequence of a first polynucleotide will hybridize with the same number of bases in a contiguous sequence of a second polynucleotide.
  • substantially complementary means that in a hybridized pair of nucleobase sequences, at least 85%, but not all, of the bases in a contiguous sequence of a first polynucleotide will hybridize with the same number of bases in a contiguous sequence of a second polynucleotide.
  • complementary may be used with respect to the base matching between the sense strand and the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent, between the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent and a sequence of a target mRNA, or between a single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide and a sequence of a target mRNA.
  • the terms “treat,” “treatment,” and the like mean the methods or steps taken to provide relief from or alleviation of the number, severity, and/or frequency of one or more symptoms of a disease in a subject.
  • the phrase “introducing into a cell,” when referring to an oligomeric compound, means functionally delivering the oligomeric compound into a cell.
  • the phrase “functional delivery,” means that delivering the oligomeric compound to the cell in a manner that enables the oligomeric compound to have the expected biological activity, e.g., sequence-specific inhibition of gene expression.
  • isomers refers to compounds that have identical molecular formulae, but that differ in the nature or the sequence of bonding of their atoms or in the arrangement of their atoms in space. Isomers that differ in the arrangement of their atoms in space are termed “stereoisomers.” Stereoisomers that are not mirror images of one another are termed “diastereoisomers,” and stereoisomers that are non-superimposable mirror images are termed “enantiomers,” or sometimes optical isomers. A carbon atom bonded to four non-identical substituents is termed a “chiral center.”
  • each structure disclosed herein is intended to represent all such possible isomers, including their optically pure and racemic forms.
  • the structures disclosed herein are intended to cover mixtures of diastereomers as well as single stereoisomers.
  • substituted means that any one or more hydrogens on the designated atom, usually a carbon, oxygen, or nitrogen atom, is replaced with any group as defined herein, provided that the designated atom's normal valency is not exceeded, and that the substitution results in a stable compound.
  • Non-limiting examples of substituents include C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, cyano, hydroxyl, oxo, carboxyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, aryl, keto, alkoxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, or halo (e.g., F, Cl, Br, I).
  • a substituent is keto or oxo (i.e., ⁇ O)
  • Ring double bonds are double bonds that are formed between two adjacent ring atoms (e.g., C ⁇ C, C ⁇ N, N ⁇ N, etc.).
  • Some compounds of the present disclosure can exist in a tautomeric form that is also intended to be encompassed within the scope of the present disclosure.
  • “Tautomers” are compounds whose structures differ markedly in the arrangement of atoms, but which exist in easy and rapid equilibrium. It is to be understood that compounds of the present disclosure may be depicted as different tautomers. It should also be understood that when compounds have tautomeric forms, all tautomeric forms are intended to be within the scope of the disclosure, and the naming of the compounds does not exclude any tautomeric form.
  • the compounds and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the present disclosure can exist in one or more tautomeric forms, including ketone—enol, amide—nitrile, lactam—lactim, amide—imidic acid tautomerism in heterocyclic rings (e.g., in the nucleobases guanine, thymine, and cytosine), amine—enamine and enamine—enamine and geometric isomers and mixtures thereof.
  • Ring-chain tautomerism exhibited by glucose and other sugars, arises as a result of the aldehyde group (—CHO) in a sugar chain molecule reacting with one of the hydroxy groups (—OH) in the same molecule to give it a cyclic (ring-shaped) form.
  • Tautomers exist as mixtures of a tautomeric set in solution. In solid form, usually one tautomer predominates. Even though one tautomer may be described, the present disclosure includes all tautomers of the compounds disclosed herein.
  • the concept of tautomers that are interconvertible by tautomerizations is called tautomerism. In tautomerism, a simultaneous shift of electrons and a hydrogen atom occurs.
  • Tautomerizations are catalyzed by: Base: 1. deprotonation; 2. formation of a delocalized anion (e.g. an enolate); 3. protonation at a different position of the anion; Acid: 1. protonation; 2. formation of a delocalized cation; 3. deprotonation at a different position adjacent to the cation.
  • Base 1. deprotonation; 2. formation of a delocalized anion (e.g. an enolate); 3. protonation at a different position of the anion
  • Acid 1. protonation; 2. formation of a delocalized cation; 3. deprotonation at a different position adjacent to the cation.
  • alkyl refers to a saturated aliphatic hydrocarbon group, straight chain or branched, having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms unless otherwise specified.
  • C1-C6 alkyl includes alkyl groups having 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 carbons in a linear or branched arrangement.
  • aminoalkyl refers to an alkyl group as defined above, substituted at any position with one or more amino groups as permitted by normal valency. The amino groups may be unsubstituted, monosubstituted, or di-substituted.
  • cycloalkyl means a saturated or unsaturated nonaromatic hydrocarbon ring group having from 3 to 14 carbon atoms, unless otherwise specified.
  • cycloalkyl groups include, but are not limited to, cyclopropyl, methyl-cyclopropyl, 2,2-dimethyl-cyclobutyl, 2-ethyl-cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, etc.
  • Cycloalkyls may include multiple spiro- or fused rings. Cycloalkyl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • alkenyl refers to a non-aromatic hydrocarbon radical, straight or branched, containing at least one carbon-carbon double bond, and having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms unless otherwise specified. Up to five carbon-carbon double bonds may be present in such groups.
  • C2-C6 alkenyl is defined as an alkenyl radical having from 2 to 6 carbon atoms. Examples of alkenyl groups include, but are not limited to, ethenyl, propenyl, butenyl, and cyclohexenyl.
  • the straight, branched, or cyclic portion of the alkenyl group may contain double bonds and is optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • cycloalkenyl means a monocyclic hydrocarbon group having the specified number of carbon atoms and at least one carbon-carbon double bond.
  • alkynyl refers to a hydrocarbon radical, straight or branched, containing from 2 to 10 carbon atoms, unless otherwise specified, and containing at least one carbon-carbon triple bond. Up to 5 carbon-carbon triple bonds may be present.
  • C2-C6 alkynyl means an alkynyl radical having from 2 to 6 carbon atoms. Examples of alkynyl groups include, but are not limited to, ethynyl, 2-propynyl, and 2-butynyl.
  • the straight or branched portion of the alkynyl group may contain triple bonds as permitted by normal valency, and may be optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • alkoxyl refers to an alkyl group as defined above with the indicated number of carbon atoms attached through an oxygen bridge.
  • C 1-6 alkoxy is intended to include C 1 , C 2 , C 3 , C 4 , C 5 , and C 6 alkoxy groups.
  • C 1-8 alkoxy is intended to include C 1 , C 2 , C 3 , C 4 , C 5 , C 6 , C 7 , and C 9 alkoxy groups.
  • alkoxy examples include, but are not limited to, methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, i-propoxy, n-butoxy, s-butoxy, t-butoxy, n-pentoxy, s-pentoxy, n-heptoxy, and n-octoxy.
  • keto refers to any alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, or aryl group as defined herein attached through a carbonyl bridge.
  • keto groups include, but are not limited to, alkanoyl (e.g., acetyl, propionyl, butanoyl, pentanoyl, hexanoyl), alkenoyl (e.g., acryloyl) alkynoyl (e.g., ethynoyl, propynoyl, butynoyl, pentynoyl, hexynoyl), aryloyl (e.g., benzoyl), heteroaryloyl (e.g., pyrroloyl, imidazoloyl, quinolinoyl, pyridinoyl).
  • alkanoyl e.g., acetyl, propionyl, butanoyl, pentanoyl, hexanoyl
  • alkenoyl e.g., acryloyl alkynoyl (e.g.
  • alkoxycarbonyl refers to any alkoxy group as defined above attached through a carbonyl bridge (i.e., —C(O)O-alkyl).
  • alkoxycarbonyl groups include, but are not limited to, methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, iso-propoxycarbonyl, n-propoxycarbonyl, t-butoxycarbonyl, benzyloxycarbonyl or n-pentoxycarbonyl.
  • aryloxycarbonyl refers to any aryl group as defined herein attached through an oxycarbonyl bridge (i.e., —C(O)O-aryl).
  • aryloxycarbonyl groups include, but are not limited to, phenoxycarbonyl and naphthyloxycarbonyl.
  • heteroaryloxycarbonyl refers to any heteroaryl group as defined herein attached through an oxycarbonyl bridge (i.e., —C(O)O-heteroaryl).
  • heteroaryloxycarbonyl groups include, but are not limited to, 2-pyridyloxycarbonyl, 2-oxazolyloxycarbonyl, 4-thiazolyloxycarbonyl, or pyrimidinyloxycarbonyl.
  • aryl or “aromatic” means any stable monocyclic or polycyclic carbon ring of up to 7 atoms in each ring, wherein at least one ring is aromatic.
  • aryl groups include, but are not limited to, phenyl, naphthyl, anthracenyl, tetrahydronaphthyl, indanyl, and biphenyl. In cases where the aryl substituent is bicyclic and one ring is non-aromatic, it is understood that attachment is via the aromatic ring.
  • Aryl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • heteroaryl represents a stable monocyclic or polycyclic ring of up to 7 atoms in each ring, wherein at least one ring is aromatic and contains from 1 to 4 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, N and S.
  • heteroaryl groups include, but are not limited to, acridinyl, carbazolyl, cinnolinyl, quinoxalinyl, pyrrazolyl, indolyl, benzotriazolyl, furanyl, thienyl, benzothienyl, benzofuranyl, benzimidazolonyl, benzoxazolonyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, dihydroisoindolonyl, imidazopyridinyl, isoindolonyl, indazolyl, oxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, isoxazolyl, indolyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrolyl, tetrahydroquinoline.
  • Heteroaryl is also understood to include the N-oxide derivative of any nitrogen-containing heteroaryl. In cases where the heteroaryl substituent is bicyclic and one ring is non-aromatic or contains no heteroatoms, it is understood that attachment is via the aromatic ring or via the heteroatom containing ring. Heteroaryl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • heterocycle means a 3- to 14-membered aromatic or nonaromatic heterocycle containing from 1 to 4 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, N and S, including polycyclic groups.
  • heterocyclic is also considered to be synonymous with the terms “heterocycle” and “heterocyclyl” and is understood as also having the same definitions set forth herein.
  • Heterocyclyl includes the above mentioned heteroaryls, as well as dihydro and tetrahydro analogs thereof.
  • heterocyclyl groups include, but are not limited to, azetidinyl, benzoimidazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzofurazanyl, benzopyrazolyl, benzotriazolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzoxazolyl, carbazolyl, carbolinyl, cinnolinyl, furanyl, imidazolyl, indolinyl, indolyl, indolazinyl, indazolyl, isobenzofuranyl, isoindolyl, isoquinolyl, isothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, naphthpyridinyl, oxadiazolyl, oxooxazolidinyl, oxazolyl, oxazoline, oxopiperazinyl, oxopyrrolidinyl, oxomorpholinyl, isoxazoline, oxetanyl, pyranyl,
  • Heterocyclyl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • the compounds and compositions disclosed herein may have certain atoms (e.g., N, O, or S atoms) in a protonated or deprotonated state, depending upon the environment in which the compound or composition is placed. Accordingly, as used herein, the structures disclosed herein envisage that certain functional groups, such as, for example, OH, SH, or NH, may be protonated or deprotonated. The disclosure herein is intended to cover the disclosed compounds and compositions regardless of their state of protonation based on the pH of the environment, as would be readily understood by the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • the phrase “consisting of” excludes any element, step, or ingredient not specified in the claim.
  • the phrase “consisting essentially of” limits the scope of a claim to the specified materials or steps and those that do not materially affect the basic and novel characteristic(s) of the claimed invention.
  • FIG. 1 is a 1 H NMR spectra of compound 11 (which is described below in Example 1 and has the chemical structure of Structure 1005b herein).
  • FIG. 1A is a 1 H NMR spectra of Structure 1004b herein (which is described below in Example 1).
  • FIG. 2 is a 31 P NMR spectra of compound 19 (which is described below in Example 2 and has the chemical structure of Structure 1008b herein.).
  • FIG. 2A is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 19.
  • FIG. 2B is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 14 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2C is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 15 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2D is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 16 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2E is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 17 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2F is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 18 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 3 is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 30 (which is described below in Example 3).
  • FIG. 4 is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 38 (which is described below in Example 4).
  • FIG. 5 is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 44 (which is described below in Example 5).
  • FIG. 6 is a 1 H NMR spectra of Compound 47 (which is described below in Example 6).
  • FIG. 7 is a photograph of a PEG linker-GalNAc phosphoramidite-containing compound in a bottle (which is described below in Example 7).
  • FIG. 8 is a photograph of Structure 1008b phosphoramidite-containing compound in a bottle (which is described below in Example 7).
  • FIG. 9 is a 31 P NMR spectra of a PEG linker-GalNAc Structure (which is described below in Example 8).
  • FIG. 10 is a graph illustrating normalized mouse Factor 12 (mF12) protein levels in wild type mice (which is described below in Example 11).
  • FIG. 11 is a graph illustrating normalized mouse Factor 12 (F12) protein levels in wild type mice (which is described below in Example 12).
  • FIG. 12 is a graph illustrating normalized lipoprotein(a) (Lp(a)) particle levels in Lp(a) transgenic (Tg) mice (which is described below in Example 13).
  • FIG. 13 is a graph illustrating normalized apo(a) levels in apo(a) transgenic (Tg) mice (which is described below in Example 14).
  • FIG. 14 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in Lp(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 15)
  • FIG. 15 is a graph illustrating normalized mouse F12 protein levels in wild type mice (which is described below in Example 16).
  • FIG. 16 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in Lp(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 17).
  • FIG. 17 is a graph illustrating normalized apo(a) levels in apo(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 18).
  • FIG. 18 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in Lp(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 19).
  • FIG. 19 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in cynomolgus monkeys (which is described below in Example 20).
  • FIG. 20 is a graph illustrating normalized cF12 protein levels in cynomolgus monkeys (which is described below in Example 21).
  • FIG. 21 is a graph illustrating normalized AAT (Z-AAT) protein levels in PiZ transgenic mice (which is described below in Example 22).
  • FIG. 22 is a structure showing Formula I.
  • FIG. 23 is a structure showing Formula I.
  • targeting ligands that are linked to compounds, such as therapeutic or diagnostic compounds.
  • the compounds that are linked to the targeting ligands described herein include or consist of therapeutic compounds such as expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds.
  • the targeting ligands can be used to target therapeutic compounds to a desired location of a target nucleic acid or target gene.
  • compositions including targeting ligands and therapeutic compounds such as compositions including or consisting of targeting ligands and expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds.
  • the new targeting ligands described herein provide advantages over previously known targeting ligands to facilitate the delivery of therapeutic compounds. These advantages include, for example, improvements to the ease and efficiency of manufacture, while also providing efficient targeting or bio-distribution, sufficient stability in vivo and/or in vitro, and/or other improvements desirable for oligonucleotide therapeutic product delivery.
  • the new targeting ligands are also particularly suitable for synthesis as phosphoramidite compounds, which reduces the cost and burden of manufacture, and facilitates the convenient attachment of the targeting ligand to compounds, especially expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (such as RNAi agents), while providing similar, or in some cases improved, delivery and/or efficacy of the therapeutic compound.
  • Targeting ligands are comprised of one or more targeting group(s) or targeting moiety(ies), which can serve to enhance the pharmacokinetic or bio-distribution properties of the compound to which they are linked, and improve cell- or tissue-specific distribution and cell-specific uptake of the conjugated composition.
  • a targeting ligand aids in directing the delivery of the therapeutic compound to which it is linked to the desired target site.
  • the targeting moiety may bind to a cell or cell receptor, and initiate endocytosis to facilitate entry of the therapeutic compound into the cell.
  • Targeting moieties can include compounds with affinity to cell receptors or cell surface molecules or antibodies.
  • targeting ligands that contain targeting moieties can be linked to therapeutic agents and other compounds to target the agents to cells and specific cellular receptors.
  • Types of targeting moieties include carbohydrates, cholesterol and cholesteryl groups, and steroids.
  • Targeting moieties that can bind to cell receptors include saccharides, such as galactose, galactose derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine), mannose, and mannose derivatives; other carbohydrates; glycans; haptens; vitamins; folate; biotin; aptamers; and peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and transferrin.
  • Targeting moieties that are known to bind to the asialoglycoprotein receptor are particularly useful in directing the delivery of oligomeric compounds to the liver.
  • Asialoglycoprotein receptors are abundantly expressed on liver cells, including hepatocytes.
  • Cell receptor targeting moieties that target ASGPR include galactose and galactose derivatives.
  • clusters of galactose derivatives including clusters comprised of two, three, or four N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG), can facilitate uptake of certain compounds in liver cells.
  • GalNAc clusters conjugated to oligomeric compounds serve to direct the composition to the liver, where the N-acetyl-galactosamine sugars are able to bind to the asialoglycoprotein receptors on the surface of the liver cell.
  • the binding to an asialoglycoprotein receptor is believed to initiate receptor-mediated endocytosis, thereby facilitating entry of the compound into the interior of the cell.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein may include one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties linked to a branch point group. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties linked to a branch point group wherein each targeting moiety is linked to the branch point group via a tether.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four asialoglycoprotein receptor (ASGPR) targeting moieties linked to a branch point group.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four ASGPR targeting moieties linked to a branch point group wherein each ASGPR targeting moiety is linked to the branch point group via a tether.
  • ASGPR asialoglycoprotein receptor
  • the branch point group is linked to a linker. In some embodiments, the branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety, and the branch point group is linked to a therapeutic compound. In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to an oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the targeting ligand is represented by the following Formula I, as shown in FIG. 22 , wherein n is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3 or 4) (Formula I). In some embodiments, n in Formula I is an integer from 1-3, 1-2, 2-4, 2-3, or 3-4.
  • the linker of Formula I is a group that includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted moieties selected from cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl group(s), or covalently linked combination(s) thereof, that connects a branch point group on one end of the linker to a therapeutic compound (or to the phosphorous atom of a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is synthesized as a phosphoramidite compound) on the other end of the linker.
  • one or more additional groups such as cleavable moieties (such as phosphate group or a group containing a disulfide bond) or groups forming phosphorothioate or phosphonate linkage(s), are inserted between the therapeutic compound and the linker.
  • the linkers are “rigid” in that they impart sufficient stability and rigidity to the overall targeting ligand to reduce interaction between the targeting moiety(ies) of Formula I and the therapeutic compound to which it is linked. This, in turn, can improve the interaction of the targeting moiety with the target site.
  • linkers for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein are specifically designed for synthesizing the targeting ligand(s) as phosphoramidite compounds, which enables the efficient linkage of the targeting ligand to the 5′ terminal end of an oligomeric compound.
  • the branch point group of Formula I is any group that enables attachment of one or more targeting moieties (via one or more tethers) to the linker.
  • the targeting ligand is represented by the following Formula II, as shown in FIG. 23 , wherein n is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3 or 4). In some embodiments, n in Formula II is an integer from 1-3, 1-2, 2-4, 2-3, or 3-4.
  • the branch point group is any group that enables attachment of one or more targeting moieties (via one or more tethers) to a therapeutic compound (or to the phosphorous atom of a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is synthesized as a phosphoramidite compound) via a linker replacement moiety.
  • a branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety when the branch point group includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl group(s), or combination(s) thereof (including fused, within the branch point group, which serves the same function as the rigid linkers of Formula I as disclosed herein.
  • the one or more tethers of Formula I and II are groups that serve as a spacer that may further add flexibility and/or length to the linkage between the targeting moiety and the branch point group.
  • the tether provides an efficient way to link a targeting moiety to the branch point group.
  • the targeting moieties of Formulas I and II are groups that serve to enhance the pharmacokinetic or bio-distribution properties of the therapeutic compound to which they are linked, and improve cell- or tissue-specific distribution and cell-specific uptake of the conjugated composition.
  • Targeting moieties can include compounds with affinity to cell receptors or cell surface molecules or antibodies.
  • Types of targeting moieties include carbohydrates, cholesterol and cholesteryl groups, and steroids.
  • Targeting moieties that can bind to cell receptors include saccharides, such as galactose, galactose derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine), mannose, and mannose derivatives; other carbohydrates; glycans; haptens; vitamins; folate; biotin; aptamers; and peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and transferrin.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein can be linked to therapeutic compounds.
  • the targeting ligand is linked to the therapeutic compound via an additional linker and/or a cleavable moiety, which is then linked to the therapeutic compound.
  • targeting ligands are ligated to the therapeutic compound itself.
  • the therapeutic compound is an oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the therapeutic compound is an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • a targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 3′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 5′ end or the 3′ end of the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 5′ end or the 3′ end of a single-stranded RNAi agent.
  • a targeting ligand is linked to a double-stranded RNAi agent via a phosphate, phosphonate, phosphorothioate, or other internucleoside linking group, at the 5′ end of the terminal nucleoside of the sense strand of the double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • a targeting ligand disclosed herein includes a cleavable moiety.
  • a cleavable moiety includes or consists of a phosphate or other internucleoside linking group that may be cleaved.
  • the targeting ligand is linked to a therapeutic compound via a cleavable moiety.
  • a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked to an additional group or groups that includes a cleavable moiety. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to a cleavable moiety, which is then linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound.
  • a phosphoramidite compound including a targeting ligand described herein may be useful to readily attach the targeting ligand to the therapeutic compound or to other groups, using methods generally known in the art for phosphoramidite synthesis.
  • the phosphoramidite compound including the targeting ligand is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound using methods generally known in the art.
  • the targeting ligand-containing phosphoramidite is linked to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand includes a single-stranded oligonucleotide.
  • the single-stranded oligonucleotide is a single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide.
  • the targeting ligand is linked directly to a single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide.
  • additional groups are inserted between a targeting ligand and a single-stranded oligonucleotide.
  • the targeting ligand linked to an RNAi agent includes one or more N-acetyl-galactosamine sugars as a targeting moiety or targeting moieties.
  • the targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound includes a tether that includes polyethylene glycol (PEG).
  • a tether consists of PEG.
  • a tether includes a PEG having 1 to 10 ethylene glycol units.
  • a tether includes a PEG having 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 ethylene glycol units.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to any of the targeting ligands disclosed herein includes an RNAi agent.
  • a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked, either directly or indirectly, to an RNAi agent.
  • a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked directly to an RNAi agent. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked indirectly to an RNAi agent, as additional group(s) are inserted between the RNAi agent and the linker of the targeting ligand. In some embodiments, a second linker is included between the linker and the therapeutic compound.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise a linker, as shown in Formula I, or alternatively the branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety, as shown in Formula I.
  • the linker is a group of atoms linked to a branch point group on one end, and linked to a therapeutic compound (or to the phosphorous atom of a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is synthesized as a phosphoramidite compound) on the other end.
  • the linker is linked to a branch point group on one end, and is ligated on the other end to a group or groups that are then ligated to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the linker is directly linked to an oligomeric compound.
  • the linker is linked to a cleavable moiety, which is then linked to an oligomeric compound.
  • cleavable moieties include, for example, phosphate groups, groups including a disulfide moiety, and/or other internucleoside linkages that may be cleaved.
  • the linker is not linked to a cleavable moiety.
  • the linker is linked to a phosphorothioate or phosphonate group.
  • the linker is a “rigid” linker.
  • a rigid linker is a linking group that includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl group(s), or covalently linked combination(s) thereof.
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • n′ is an integer from 0 to 10 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10), and for each Z′ present, Z′ is independently selected, and Z′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstitute
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • n′′ is an integer from 0 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3 or 4), and for each Z′′ present, Z′′ is independently selected, and Z′′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbon
  • the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • V includes or consists of one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, be
  • the linkers suitable for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein are generated from a compound that includes a rigid structure with a terminal carboxylic acid moiety (or activated ester thereof) on one end, and a terminal alcohol moiety on the other end.
  • the alcohol moiety is a secondary alcohol.
  • the alcohol moiety is a tertiary alcohol.
  • the alcohol moiety is a primary alcohol.
  • the carboxylic acid moiety (or activated ester thereof) is suitable for attachment to the branch point group, while the alcohol moiety is suitable for attachment to the phosphorus atom of a phosphoramidite through a phosphitylation reaction with a phosphoramidite forming reagent.
  • Example phosphitylation reactions using phosphoramidite forming reagents are described in the Examples herein.
  • the linker structures disclosed herein are suitable for preparation of the targeting ligand as a phosphoramidite compound.
  • the linker is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound that is a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to the 3′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments the linker is linked to the 3′ end of the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to the 5′ end of the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • the linker is linked to a cleavable moiety.
  • a terminal phosphate group of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can serve as a cleavable moiety.
  • an independently selected cleavable moiety is linked to a linker.
  • a cleavable moiety is a group that is stable outside of the cell, but upon entry into the target cell is cleaved. Cleavable moieties are susceptible to cleavage under certain conditions, such as pH, or certain cleavage agents, such as molecules that promote degradation or redox agents.
  • the cleavable moiety may be susceptible to pH.
  • endosomes and lysosomes are known to generally have a more acidic pH (pH of approximately 4.5 to 6.5) than human blood (pH of approximately 7.35 to 7.45), and as such may promote the cleavage of a cleavable moiety.
  • a cleavable moiety is a phosphate group.
  • Phosphate groups may be cleaved by agents that are known to degrade or hydrolyze phosphate groups.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise a branch point group that includes a linker replacement group, instead of a linker, as shown in Formula II.
  • the linker replacement moiety is a part of the branch point group.
  • the linkers and linker replacement moieties disclosed herein permits the incorporation of only a single isomer of a targeting ligand, which can provide additional advantages for oligonucleotide therapeutic products.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise at least one branch point group.
  • the branch point group of the targeting ligands disclosed herein is linked to a linker.
  • the branch point group is linked to a linker on one end, and the branch point group is linked to one or more tethers on the other end(s).
  • the branch point group is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound via an additional group or groups.
  • the branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety and is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • branch point groups disclosed herein can be of any group which permits attachment of one or more targeting moieties and further permits attachment to a linker disclosed herein, or, alternatively, if the branch point group comprises a linker replacement moiety, the branch point group can be any group that includes a linker replacement moiety that permits attachment to a therapeutic compound, such as an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the branch point group compound that serves to generate the branch point group has one terminal amine for each desired linkage to a linker, and one terminal carboxylic acid moiety (or activated ester thereof) for each desired linkage to a tether.
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point having a structure selected from the following:
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 1 to 20 (Structure 209).
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20) (Structure 210).
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the structure represented by the following:
  • m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • x is an integer from to 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10);
  • y is an integer from 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • z is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4);
  • K is selected from the group consisting of substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • x is an integer from to 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10);
  • y is an integer from 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10) (Structure 212).
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20);
  • x is an integer from to 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10);
  • y is an integer from 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10); and G is selected from the group consisting of
  • substituted or unsubstituted cyclic or heterocyclic structure having a ring size of 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 atoms for example, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, an
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20) (Structure 214).
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and Q is selected from the group consisting of:
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • n in Structure 219 is 1. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 2. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 3. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 4. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 5. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 6. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 7.
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group that includes a linker replacement group.
  • the targeting ligand includes a branch point group that includes a linker replacement moiety having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise one or more tethers.
  • a tether is linked between the branch point group and each targeting moiety.
  • the tether is linked directly to the targeting ligand on one end and directly to the branch point group on the other end.
  • the tether is linked directly to the targeting ligand on one end, and indirectly to the branch point group on the other end.
  • the tether is linked indirectly to the targeting ligand on one end and indirectly to the branch point group on the other end.
  • a targeting ligand described herein includes three tethers and three targeting moieties.
  • a targeting ligand described herein includes four tethers and four targeting moieties.
  • a targeting ligand described herein includes one tether and one targeting moiety.
  • a targeting ligand described herein includes multiple tethers and multiple targeting moieties.
  • additional tethers or other groups are inserted between the tether and the targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I.
  • a second tether is inserted between a tether and a targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I.
  • a second tether and a third tether is inserted between a tether and a targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I.
  • a second, third, and fourth tether is inserted between a tether and a targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein are intended to cover such compositions.
  • additional groups can be inserted between the tether and the branch point group of Formula I or Formula I.
  • the tether serves as a spacer that may further add flexibility and/or length to the linkage between the targeting moiety and the branch point group, linker, and therapeutic compound.
  • the tether includes alkyl groups (including cycloalkyl groups), alkenyl groups (including cycloalkenyl groups), alkynyl groups, aryl groups, aralkyl groups, aralkenyl groups, or aralkynyl groups.
  • the tether includes one or more heteroatoms, heterocycles, heteroaryls, amino acids, nucleotides, or saccharides.
  • the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH (Structure 301).
  • the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH. (Structure 303).
  • the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH. (Structure 304).
  • the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • the targeting ligand includes more than one type of tether.
  • the tether acts as a flexible hydrophilic spacer (See, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,885,968; and Biessen et al. J. Med. Chem. 1995, 39, 1538-1546, both of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety), and includes a PEG spacer.
  • the PEG spacer has 1 to 20 ethylene units (PEG 1 to PEG 20 ).
  • the PEG spacer has 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 ethylene units.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one to four, or more than four, targeting moieties.
  • the targeting ligands may be a galactose cluster.
  • a galactose cluster includes a targeting ligand having two to four terminal galactose derivatives.
  • galactose derivative includes both galactose and derivatives of galactose having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor equal to or greater than that of galactose.
  • a galactose derivative is a saccharide sugar that is a type of targeting moiety.
  • a terminal galactose derivative is linked to a tether through the C-1 carbon of the saccharide.
  • the targeting ligand is comprised of three terminal galactosamines or galactosamine derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine) each having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor.
  • the targeting ligand includes three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG) as the targeting moieties.
  • GalNAc or NAG N-acetyl-galactosamines
  • each of Structures 1001, 1002, 1004 and 1008 are targeting ligands having three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines as the targeting moieties.
  • each targeting moiety includes a galactosamine derivative that is N-acetyl-galactosamine.
  • Other saccharides having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor may be selected from the list including: galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, and N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
  • the affinities of numerous galactose derivatives for the asialoglycoprotein receptor have been studied (see, for example, Iobst, S. T. and Drickamer, K J.B.C. 1996, 271, 6686, which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety) or are readily determined using methods well known and commonly used in the art.
  • the targeting moiety is a cell-targeting moiety.
  • the targeting moiety includes an N-acetyl-galactosamine:
  • the targeting ligand includes three targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes four targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes one targeting moiety. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes two targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes four or more targeting moieties.
  • the targeting moiety includes one or more of galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, or N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
  • the N-acetyl-galactosamine targeting moieties in any of Structures 1001 through 1027 can be replaced with alternative targeting moieties.
  • alternative targeting moieties include, for example, galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, or N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
  • the targeting moieties of Structures 1001 through 1027 may be replaced with, for example, other carbohydrates; glycans; haptens; vitamins; folate; biotin; aptamers; and/or peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and/or transferrin.
  • the targeting ligand is in the form of an N-acetyl-galactosamine trimer. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is in the form of an N-acetyl-galactosamine tetramer.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein may be comprised of one or more targeting moieties, tethers, branch point groups, and linkers.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein may be comprised of one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein are synthesized to be in the form of a phosphoramidite compound. Phosphoramidites are widely used in the chemical synthesis of RNA and DNA.
  • the phosphoramidite-containing targeting ligands disclosed herein are added to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. It can be especially advantageous to prepare the targeting ligand as a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is to be linked to the 5′ terminal end of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • preparing the targeting ligand as a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is linked to the 5′ terminal end of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound allows for the linkage of the targeting ligand as the last component (thus reducing manufacturing costs), as well as potentially permits the targeting ligand to block the loading of the sense strand into RISC when the targeting ligand is attached to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • the targeting ligand can be prepared as a phosphoramidite compound when the targeting ligand is to be linked to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of the RNAi agent.
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, Y is O or S; and Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ . (Structure 1003a(i)).
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure re resented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented b the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, Y is O or S; and Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and includes the structure represented by the following;
  • J includes or consists of one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl groups, or covalently linked combinations thereof;
  • Y is O or S;
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound;
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ (Structure 1011).
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the linker of the targeting ligand may be absent, so long as the branch point group includes at least one aryl, cycloalkyl, and/or heterocyclic group. Having one or more aryl, cycloalkyl, and/or heterocyclic groups located within the branch point group serves as a linker replacement group. In some embodiments, the one or more aryl, cycloalkyl, and/or heterocyclic groups within the branch point group are positioned between the central connection point(s) of the branch point group and the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound
  • Y is O or S
  • Y′ is O ⁇ , S ⁇ , or NH ⁇ .
  • the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • the targeting ligand is in the form of a galactose cluster.
  • a galactose cluster includes a targeting ligand having two to four terminal galactose derivatives.
  • galactose derivative includes both galactose and derivatives of galactose having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor equal to or greater than that of galactose.
  • a galactose derivative is a saccharide sugar that is a type of targeting moiety.
  • a terminal galactose derivative may be linked to a tether through the C-1 carbon of the saccharide.
  • the targeting ligand is comprised of three terminal galactosamines or galactosamine derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine) each having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor.
  • the targeting ligand includes three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG) as the targeting moieties.
  • the targeting ligand is comprised of four terminal galactosamines or galactosamine derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine) each having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor.
  • the targeting ligand includes four terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG) as the targeting moieties.
  • each targeting moiety includes a galactosamine derivative that is N-acetyl-galactosamine.
  • Other saccharides having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor may be selected from the list including: galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, and N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
  • the affinities of numerous galactose derivatives for the asialoglycoprotein receptor have been studied (see for example: Iobst, S. T. and Drickamer, K J.B.C. 1996, 271, 6686) or are readily determined using methods well known and commonly used in the art.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein can be linked to an oligomeric compound.
  • the oligomeric compound is an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a single-stranded oligonucleotide.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds may be synthesized using methods commonly used in the art.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds may include one or more modified nucleotides.
  • a nucleotide base is a heterocyclic pyrimidine or purine compound which is a constituent of all nucleic acids and includes adenine (A), guanine (G), cytosine (C), thymine (T), and uracil (U).
  • nucleotide may include a modified nucleotide or nucleotide mimic, abasic site, or a surrogate replacement moiety.
  • a “modified nucleotide” is a nucleotide, nucleotide mimic, abasic site, or a surrogate replacement moiety other than a ribonucleotide (2′-hydroxyl nucleotide).
  • a modified nucleotide includes a 2′-modified nucleotide (i.e. a nucleotide with a group other than a hydroxyl group at the 2′ position of the five-membered sugar ring).
  • Modified nucleotides include, but are not limited to: 2′-modified nucleotides, 2′-O-methyl nucleotides (represented herein as a lower case letter ‘n’ in a nucleotide sequence), 2′-deoxy-2′-fluoro nucleotides (represented herein as Nf, also represented herein as 2′-fluoro nucleotide), 2′-deoxy nucleotides (represented herein as dN), 2′-methoxyethyl (2′-O-2-methoxylethyl) nucleotides, (represented herein as NM or 2′-MOE), 2′-amino nucleotides, 2′-alkyl nucleotides, 3′ to 3′ linkages (inverted) nucleotides (represented herein as invdN, invN, invn, invX), non-natural base including nucleotides, locked nucleotides, bridged nucleotides, peptid
  • Modified nucleobases include synthetic and natural nucleobases, such as 5-substituted pyrimidines, 6-azapyrimidines, N-2-, N-6-, and O-6-substituted purines (e.g., 2-aminopropyladenine), 5-propynyluracil, 5-propynylcytosine, 5-methylcytosine (5-me-C), 5-hydroxymethyl cytosine, xanthine, hypoxanthine, 2-aminoadenine, 6-methyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-propyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-thiouracil, 2-thiothymine, 2-thiocytosine, 5-halouracil, 5-halocytosine, 5-propynyl uracil, 5-propynyl cytosine, 6-azo-uracil, 6-azo-cytosine, 6-azo-thymine, 5-uracil (
  • any modified nucleotides may be linked by phosphate-containing or non-phosphate-containing covalent internucleoside linkages.
  • Modified internucleoside linkages or backbones include, but are not limited to, 5′-phosphorothioate group (represented herein as a lower case ‘s’ before a nucleotide, as in sN, sn, sNf, or sdN), chiral phosphorothioates, thiophosphate, phosphorodithioates, phosphotriesters, aminoalkyl-phosphotriesters, methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3′-alkylene phosphonates and chiral phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3′-amino phosphoramidate and aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkyl-phosphonates, thionoalkyl-phosphonates, thionoalkyl
  • a modified internucleoside linkage or backbone lacks a phosphorus atom.
  • Modified internucleoside linkages lacking a phosphorus atom include, but are not limited to, short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl inter-sugar linkages, mixed heteroatom and alkyl or cycloalkyl inter-sugar linkages, or one or more short chain heteroatomic or heterocyclic inter-sugar linkages.
  • modified internucleoside backbones include, but are not limited to, siloxane backbones, sulfide backbones, sulfoxide backbones, sulfone backbones, formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones, methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones, alkene-containing backbones, sulfamate backbones, methyleneimino and methylenehydrazino backbones, sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones, amide backbones, and other backbones having mixed N, O, S, and CH 2 components.
  • an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent, and includes a sense strand and an antisense strand that are at least partially complementary (at least 70% complementary) to each other.
  • the antisense strand contains a region having a sequence that is perfectly complementary (100% complementary) or at least substantially complementary (at least 85% complementary) to a sequence in a target mRNA.
  • the length of a double-stranded RNAi agent sense strand and antisense strand each can be 16 to 30 nucleotides in length.
  • the sense and antisense strands can be either the same length or they can be different lengths.
  • the sense strand is about 19 nucleotides in length while the antisense strand is about 21 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, the sense strand is about 21 nucleotides in length while the antisense strand is about 23 nucleotides in length. In other embodiments, the sense and antisense strands are each independently 17-21 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, both the sense and antisense strands are each 21-26 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, both the sense and antisense strands are each 26 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, the sense and antisense strands are each independently 17 to 26 nucleotides in length.
  • a double-stranded RNAi agent has a duplex length of about 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23 or 24 nucleotides.
  • This region of perfect or substantial complementarity between the sense strand and the antisense strand is typically 15-25 (e.g., 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, or 25 nucleotides in length) nucleotides in length and occurs at or near the 5′ end of the antisense strand.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds that are conjugated to the ligands disclosed herein optionally and independently include an additional 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 nucleotides (as an extension) at the 3′ end, the 5′ end, or both the 3′ and 5′ ends of the core sequences.
  • additional nucleotides if present, may or may not be complementary to the corresponding sequence in the targeted mRNA.
  • the additional sense strand additional nucleotides when a double-stranded RNAi agent is conjugated to the targeting ligands disclosed herein, may or may not be identical to the corresponding sequence in the targeted mRNA.
  • the additional antisense strand additional nucleotides, if present, may or may not be complementary to the corresponding additional nucleotides of the sense strand, if present.
  • Double-stranded RNAi agents can be formed by annealing an antisense strand with a sense strand.
  • the targeting ligand is linked to an RNAi agent at the 3′ or 5′ end of either the sense strand or the antisense strand of the RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to 5′ end of the sense strand. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to the 3′ end of the sense strand. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to the RNAi agent via a labile, cleavable, or reversible bond. In some embodiments, the labile, cleavable, or reversible bond is included in a cleavable moiety added between the RNAi agent and the targeting ligand.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a single-stranded oligonucleotide.
  • the single-stranded oligonucleotide is utilizes the RNA interference mechanism to inhibit expression of the target mRNA.
  • the single-stranded oligonucleotides are active in reducing expression of the target nucleic acid through a mechanism other than RNA interference.
  • the gene expression level and/or mRNA level of a target in a subject to whom a described targeting ligand conjugated to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, by at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject prior to administration or to a subject not receiving the targeting ligand conjugate.
  • the gene expression level and/or mRNA level in the subject may be reduced in a cell, group of cells, and/or tissue of the subject.
  • the protein level in a subject to whom a described targeting ligand conjugated to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound has been administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, by at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject prior to being administered the targeting ligand conjugate or to a subject not receiving the targeting ligand conjugate.
  • the protein level in the subject may be reduced in a cell, group of cells, tissue, blood, and/or other fluid of the subject.
  • a reduction in gene expression, mRNA, or protein levels can be assessed by any methods known in the art. Reduction or decrease in mRNA level and/or protein level are collectively referred to herein as inhibiting, decreasing, or reducing the expression of the targeted gene.
  • LPA apolipoprotein(a) gene [LPA](to inhibit expression of the apo(a) protein which is part of the lipoprotein(a) particle, and thereby the lipoprotein(a) particle (Lp(a))), that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein.
  • the apo(a) gene [LPA] is expressed predominantly in the liver in humans and non-human primates.
  • RNAi Therapy for Hepatitis B Virus Infection which is also incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting the hepatitis B virus, that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein.
  • the Hepatitis B Virus is a strict hepatotrophic, double-stranded DNA containing virus and is classified as one member of the Hepadnaviruses, belonging to the family of Hepadnaviridae.
  • Factor XII is a serine protease expressed predominantly in the liver and found in blood.
  • AAT alpha-1 antitrypsin
  • WO 2016/01123 entitled Organic Compositions to Treat APOC3-Related Diseases, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting human apolipoprotein III (APOC3), that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein.
  • Apolipoprotein C-III is a constituent of lipoproteins that is believed to inhibit hepatic uptake of triglyceride-rich particles.
  • Additional references disclosing various therapeutic compounds, including expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, that may be suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein, can also be found in the art. These include, but are not limited to, compositions where targeting to the liver would be desirable.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein, when linked to an oligomeric compound, can be used to treat a subject (e.g., a human or mammal) having a disease or disorder that would benefit from administration of the compound.
  • the targeting ligands disclosed herein, when linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can be used to treat a subject (e.g., a human) having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction or inhibition in expression of the target mRNA.
  • the subject is administered a therapeutically effective amount of any one or more expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, such as an RNAi agent, that is linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein.
  • the subject can be a human, patient, or human patient.
  • the subject may be an adult, adolescent, child, or infant.
  • the described pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can be used to provide methods for the therapeutic treatment of diseases. Such methods include administration of a pharmaceutical composition described herein to a human being or animal.
  • compositions and methods disclosed herein may decrease the level of the target mRNA in a cell, group of cells, group of cells, tissue, or subject, including: administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a herein described expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound that is linked to a targeting ligand, thereby inhibiting the expression of a target mRNA in the subject.
  • the subject has been previously identified as having a pathogenic upregulation of the target gene in the targeted cell or tissue.
  • compositions include at least one expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand. These pharmaceutical compositions are particularly useful in the inhibition of the expression of the target mRNA in a target cell, a group of cells, a tissue, or an organism.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions can be used to treat a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in the level of the target mRNA, or inhibition in expression of the target gene.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions can be used to treat a subject at risk of developing a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction of the level of the target mRNA or an inhibition in expression the target gene.
  • the method includes administering a composition including a targeting ligand as described herein linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, such as an RNAi agent, to a subject to be treated.
  • a composition including a targeting ligand as described herein linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound such as an RNAi agent
  • one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients are added to the pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, thereby forming a pharmaceutical formulation suitable for in vivo delivery to a human.
  • the described pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound are used for treating or managing clinical presentations associated with expression of a target mRNA.
  • a therapeutically or prophylactically effective amount of one or more of pharmaceutical compositions is administered to a subject in need of such treatment, prevention or management.
  • administration of any of the conjugated ligands covalently linked to an oligomeric compound can be used to decrease the number, severity, and/or frequency of symptoms of a disease in a subject.
  • the described pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can be used to treat at least one symptom in a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction or inhibition in expression of a target mRNA.
  • the subject is administered a therapeutically effective amount of one or more pharmaceutical compositions including an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, such as an RNAi agent, linked to a targeting ligand described herein, thereby treating the symptom.
  • the subject is administered a prophylactically effective amount of one or more of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds thereby preventing the at least one symptom.
  • the expression or level of a target mRNA in a subject to whom an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein is administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, but at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject not receiving the pharmaceutical composition.
  • the gene expression level in the subject may be reduced in a cell, group of cells, and/or tissue of the subject.
  • the level of mRNA is reduced.
  • the expressed protein level is reduced.
  • the level of protein in a subject to whom an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein is administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, but at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject not receiving the pharmaceutical composition.
  • Reduction in expression, mRNA levels, or protein levels can be assessed by any methods known in the art. Reduction or decrease in mRNA level and/or protein level are collectively referred to herein as a reduction or decrease in target RNA or inhibiting or reducing the expression of target mRNA.
  • the route of administration is the path by which an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is brought into contact with the body.
  • methods of administering drugs and nucleic acids for treatment of a mammal are well known in the art and can be applied to administration of the compositions described herein.
  • the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to the herein described targeting ligands can be administered via any suitable route in a preparation appropriately tailored to the particular route.
  • herein described pharmaceutical compositions can be administered by injection, for example, intravenously, intramuscularly, intracutaneously, subcutaneously, intraarticularly, or intraperitoneally.
  • there herein described pharmaceutical compositions and be administered via inhalation.
  • compositions including an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand described herein can be delivered to a cell, group of cells, tumor, tissue, or subject using oligonucleotide delivery technologies known in the art.
  • any suitable method recognized in the art for delivering a nucleic acid molecule in vitro or in vivo can be adapted for use with a herein described compositions.
  • delivery can be by local administration, (e.g., direct injection, implantation, or topical administering), systemic administration, or subcutaneous, intravenous, intraperitoneal, or parenteral routes, including intracranial (e.g., intraventricular, intraparenchymal and intrathecal), intramuscular, transdermal, airway (aerosol), nasal, oral, rectal, or topical (including buccal and sublingual) administration.
  • the compositions are administered by subcutaneous or intravenous infusion or injection.
  • the herein described pharmaceutical compositions may comprise one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be formulated for administration to a subject.
  • a pharmaceutical composition or medicament includes a pharmacologically effective amount of at least one of the described therapeutic compounds and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable excipients are substances other than the Active Pharmaceutical ingredient (API, therapeutic product, e.g., F12 RNAi agent) that are intentionally included in the drug delivery system. Excipients do not exert or are not intended to exert a therapeutic effect at the intended dosage.
  • Excipients may act to a) aid in processing of the drug delivery system during manufacture, b) protect, support or enhance stability, bioavailability or patient acceptability of the API, c) assist in product identification, and/or d) enhance any other attribute of the overall safety, effectiveness, of delivery of the API during storage or use.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient may or may not be an inert substance.
  • Excipients include, but are not limited to: absorption enhancers, anti-adherents, anti-foaming agents, anti-oxidants, binders, buffering agents, carriers, coating agents, colors, delivery enhancers, delivery polymers, dextran, dextrose, diluents, disintegrants, emulsifiers, extenders, fillers, flavors, glidants, humectants, lubricants, oils, polymers, preservatives, saline, salts, solvents, sugars, suspending agents, sustained release matrices, sweeteners, thickening agents, tonicity agents, vehicles, water-repelling agents, and wetting agents.
  • compositions suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions (where water soluble) or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersion.
  • suitable carriers include physiological saline, bacteriostatic water, Cremophor ELTM (BASF, Parsippany, N.J.) or phosphate buffered saline (PBS). It should be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and should be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms such as bacteria and fungi.
  • the carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol), and suitable mixtures thereof.
  • the proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants.
  • isotonic agents for example, sugars, polyalcohols such as mannitol, sorbitol, and sodium chloride in the composition.
  • Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent which delays absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filter sterilization.
  • dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle which contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
  • methods of preparation include vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • Formulations suitable for intra-articular administration can be in the form of a sterile aqueous preparation of the drug that can be in microcrystalline form, for example, in the form of an aqueous microcrystalline suspension.
  • Liposomal formulations or biodegradable polymer systems can also be used to present the drug for both intra-articular and ophthalmic administration.
  • Formulations suitable for topical administration include liquid or semi-liquid preparations such as liniments, lotions, gels, applicants, oil-in-water or water-in-oil emulsions such as creams, ointments or pastes; or solutions or suspensions such as drops.
  • Formulations for topical administration to the skin surface can be prepared by dispersing the drug with a dermatologically acceptable carrier such as a lotion, cream, ointment or soap.
  • a dermatologically acceptable carrier such as a lotion, cream, ointment or soap.
  • the agent can be dispersed in a liquid tissue adhesive or other substance known to enhance adsorption to a tissue surface.
  • tissue-coating solutions such as pectin-containing formulations can be used.
  • inhalation of powder (self-propelling or spray formulations) dispensed with a spray can a nebulizer, or an atomizer can be used.
  • Such formulations can be in the form of a fine powder for pulmonary administration from a powder inhalation device or self-propelling powder-dispensing formulations.
  • self-propelling solution and spray formulations the effect can be achieved either by choice of a valve having the desired spray characteristics (i.e., being capable of producing a spray having the desired particle size) or by incorporating the active ingredient as a suspended powder in controlled particle size.
  • the compounds also can be delivered in the form of an aerosol spray from pressured container or dispenser which contains a suitable propellant, e.g., a gas such as carbon dioxide, or a nebulizer.
  • Systemic administration also can be by transmucosal or transdermal means.
  • penetrants appropriate to the barrier to be permeated are used in the formulation.
  • penetrants generally are known in the art, and include, for example, for transmucosal administration, detergents and bile salts.
  • Transmucosal administration can be accomplished through the use of nasal sprays or suppositories.
  • the active compounds typically are formulated into ointments, salves, gels, or creams as generally known in the art.
  • the active compounds can be prepared with carriers that will protect the compound against rapid elimination from the body, such as a controlled release formulation, including implants and microencapsulated delivery systems.
  • a controlled release formulation including implants and microencapsulated delivery systems.
  • Biodegradable, biocompatible polymers can be used, such as ethylene vinyl acetate, polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid. Methods for preparation of such formulations will be apparent to those skilled in the art.
  • Liposomal suspensions can also be used as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. These can be prepared according to methods known to those skilled in the art, for example, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,522,811.
  • Oral or parenteral compositions can be formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage.
  • Dosage unit form refers to physically discrete units suited as unitary dosages for the subject to be treated; each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active compound calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect in association with the required pharmaceutical carrier.
  • the specification for the dosage unit forms of the disclosure are dictated by and directly dependent on the unique characteristics of the active compound and the therapeutic effect to be achieved, and the limitations inherent in the art of compounding such an active compound for the treatment of individuals.
  • administration can be by periodic injections of a bolus, or can be made more continuous by intravenous, intramuscular or intraperitoneal administration from an external reservoir (e.g., an intravenous bag).
  • pharmacogenomics i.e., the study of the relationship between an individual's genotype and that individual's response to a foreign compound or drug
  • Differences in metabolism of therapeutics can lead to severe toxicity or therapeutic failure by altering the relation between dose and blood concentration of the pharmacologically active drug.
  • a physician or clinician can consider applying knowledge obtained in relevant pharmacogenomics studies in determining whether to administer a drug as well as tailoring the dosage and/or therapeutic regimen of treatment with the drug.
  • a pharmaceutical composition can contain other additional components commonly found in pharmaceutical compositions.
  • additional components include, but are not limited to: anti-pruritics, astringents, local anesthetics, or anti-inflammatory agents (e.g., antihistamine, diphenhydramine, etc.).
  • anti-pruritics e.g., antihistamine, diphenhydramine, etc.
  • anti-inflammatory agents e.g., antihistamine, diphenhydramine, etc.
  • cells, tissues or isolated organs that express or comprise the herein defined RNAi agents may be used as “pharmaceutical compositions.”
  • “pharmacologically effective amount,” “therapeutically effective amount,” or simply “effective amount” refers to that amount of an RNAi agent to produce a pharmacological, therapeutic or preventive result.
  • an effective amount of an active compound will be in the range of from about 0.1 to about 100 mg/kg of body weight/day, e.g., from about 1.0 to about 50 mg/kg of body weight/day. In some embodiments, an effective amount of an active compound will be in the range of from about 0.25 to about 5 mg/kg of body weight per dose. In some embodiments, an effective amount of an active ingredient will be in the range of from about 0.5 to about 3 mg/kg of body weight per dose.
  • the amount administered will also likely depend on such variables as the overall health status of the patient, the relative biological efficacy of the compound delivered, the formulation of the drug, the presence and types of excipients in the formulation, and the route of administration. Also, it is to be understood that the initial dosage administered can be increased beyond the above upper level in order to rapidly achieve the desired blood-level or tissue level, or the initial dosage can be smaller than the optimum.
  • compositions described herein including an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, such as an RNAi agent, linked to a targeting ligand can be combined with an excipient or with a second therapeutic agent or treatment including, but not limited to: a second or other expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, a small molecule drug, an antibody, an antibody fragment, and/or a vaccine.
  • the described targeting ligands when linked to expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, and when added to pharmaceutically acceptable excipients or adjuvants, can be packaged into kits, containers, packs, or dispensers.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions described herein may be packaged in pre-filled syringes or vials.
  • the compounds of the present disclosure can be made using synthetic chemical techniques known to those of skill in the art.
  • the Phosphoramidite-containing compound of Structure 1005b, Structure 1004b, and Structure 1002b were synthesized according to the following procedure, with the only difference being that 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8 herein) was used to synthesize compound Structure 1005b, 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8a herein) was used to synthesize compound Structure 1004b, and a mixture of 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8 herein) and 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8a herein) was used to synthesize compound Structure 1002b.
  • 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid compound 8 herein
  • 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid compound 8a herein
  • the activated ester 4 (2.15 g, 2.41 mmol) and amine tosylate 5 (4.10 g, 6.75 mmol) were dissolved in dichloromethane (22 mL) and cooled to 10° C.
  • the solution was treated with triethylamine (1.37 g, 13.54 mmol) dropwise over 5 minutes and then allowed to warm to ambient temperature and held for 2 h.
  • the reaction mixture was washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (10 mL) followed by brine (10 mL).
  • the solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated on a rotary evaporator to give a colorless oil. After workup, ⁇ 10% of the des-acyl impurity was found by HPLC.
  • NAG amine salt 7 (5.00 g, 2.88 mmol) and 2,3,5,6-tetrafluorophenyl cis-4-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylate 9 (1.68 g, 5.77 mmol) were dissolved in 25 mL dichloromethane and cooled to 0° C. To this solution was added triethylamine (1.60 mL, 11.55 mmol). The solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 5 hours with monitoring by HPLC. The reaction was quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO 3 (35 mL) and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with saturated brine (35 mL) and dried with Na 2 SO 4 .
  • a 100 mg of the crude 11 was purified by flash column chromatography by first eluting the silica gel-packed column with 2% triethylamine in dichloromethane for 30 min, followed by loading the crude 11 on the column and purifying using gradient elution (0-20% of 2% triethylamine:methanol/2% triethylamine:dichloromethane).
  • the final product compound 11 (which has the chemical structure of Structure 1005b defined herein) was eluted in 2% triethylamine:dichloromethane (Fraction 2) to give 80 mg of white solid material.
  • FIG. 1 shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 11 (Structure 1005b herein).
  • FIG. 1A shows 1 H NMR spectra for the trans-isomer of compound 11 (Structure 1004b herein), following the alternative synthesis set forth in step 7, above.
  • reaction solution was poured into a stirring solution of 0.5 M HCl (aq) (125 mL) chilled in an ice bath at 3° C. and stirred about 5 minutes.
  • the quenched reaction mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (100 mL, 10 vol.; check to make sure the aqueous layer is acidic for complete removal of NMM), and the organic phase was washed with brine (100 mL, 10 vol.), dried over Na 2 SO 4 , filtered over a coarse fritted funnel into a 500-mL round-bottomed flask, and concentrated in vacuo, affording a thick colorless oil.
  • the oil was dissolved in MTBE (100 mL, 10 vol.) and concentrated in vacuo, once again yielding a thick colorless oil.
  • FIG. 2B shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 14.
  • the reaction was diluted with toluene and acetonitrile (1500 mL each), and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo.
  • Formic acid was azeotropically removed with 1:1 ACN:toluene ( ⁇ 600 mL), and twice with ACN ( ⁇ 500 mL each).
  • the material was dried on high vacuum overnight to afford a white foamy solid (54.3 g, quantitative yield, 96.8 area % at 254 nm).
  • FIG. 2C shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 15.
  • NAG-amine p-tosylate salt 5, 59.19 g, 97.6 mmol, 4.13 equiv.
  • Z-bis-Glu triacid 15, 10.01 g, 23.6 mmol purity corrected, 1.0 equiv.
  • the residue was dissolved in fresh acetonitrile (400 mL) and transferred to a nitrogen-flushed 1-liter 3-neck round-bottomed flask containing a stir bar and equipped with a thermocouple. Water content was measured by KF (257 ppm).
  • Flash column chromatography was performed on an ISCO CombiFlash automated purification system using a 330-g ISCO RediSep Rf Gold silica column.
  • the crude material was loaded as a solution in CHCl 3 ( ⁇ 200 mL).
  • Eluent B: MeOH was utilized and a total of 36 fractions were collected (250-500 mL each).
  • Product containing fractions were concentrated and yielded 18.75 g (97.0% purity) of 16.
  • Mixed fractions yielded 12.2 g (78.8% purity) of 16.
  • FIG. 2D shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 16.
  • reaction was sampled (100 ⁇ L) and mixed with 1:1 acetonitrile:H 2 O (900 ⁇ L) in a 1-mL syringe filter (10 mm, 0.1 ⁇ m GHP membrane).
  • HPLC chromatogram showed greater than 96 area % purity, with no remaining starting material.
  • the reaction mixture was then flushed with nitrogen and filtered over a bed of Celite into a clean 1000-mL round-bottomed flask.
  • the reaction vessel was rinsed with methanol (50 mL) and dichloromethane (50 mL), and the rinses were filtered also. The slightly cloudy filtrate was partially concentrated in vacuo.
  • FIG. 2E shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 17.
  • Crude 18 (17.16 g, combined with a previous lot) was purified on an ISCO CombiFlash EZPrep automated purification system using a 330-g ISCO RediSep Rf Gold silica column.
  • the crude material was loaded as a solution in 8% MeOH/CH 2 Cl 2 ( ⁇ 160 mL).
  • Eluent B: 50% MeOH:CH 2 Cl 2 was utilized to produce 33 fractions.
  • Product containing fractions were concentrated to afford 10.13 g (98.1% pure, 59% recovery) of 18.
  • Mixed fractions were pooled to yield an additional 6.52 g (86.1% purity) of 18, which could be re-purified.
  • FIG. 2F shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 18.
  • reaction was quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO 3 (150 mL).
  • organic layer separated, washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO 3 (1 ⁇ 150 mL), and brine (1 ⁇ 150 mL), and dried with Na 2 SO 4 .
  • the drying agent was filtered and the solution was concentrated and purified via flash chromatography by first treating the silica column with dichloromethane (+1% triethylamine) for 30 minutes followed by loading the crude final product, compound 19 (which has the chemical structure of Structure 1008 herein) on the column and purified using gradient elution (0-20% MeOH (+1% TEA)/CH 2 Cl 2 (+1% TEA)) over 30 min which gave 11.1 g of compound 19 as a white solid material (76% yield, purity 96.6%).
  • FIG. 2 shows 31 P NMR spectra for Compound 19.
  • FIG. 2A shows 1 H NMR spectra for Compound 19.
  • FIG. 2 and FIG. 2A are both consistent with the structure of Compound 19 (Structure 1008b herein).
  • FIG. 3 shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 30 (Structure 1025b herein).
  • FIG. 4 shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 38 (Structure 1014b herein).
  • the phosphoramidite-containing compound of Structure 1006b and Structure 1007b were synthesized according to the following same procedure, with the only difference being that 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8 herein) was used to synthesize Structure 1006b, and 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8a herein) was used to synthesize Structure 1007b.
  • TEA 400 uL, 2.9 mmol
  • tri-TFP ester 540 mg, 0.642 mmol
  • GalNac-Peg 3 -NH 2 ⁇ TsOH 2.89 mmol, 1.88 g
  • DCM 6 mL
  • Organic layer was dried over Na 2 SO 4 , evaporated leaving a white solid. The solid was dissolved in DCM and purified on silica column.
  • FIG. 5 shows 1 H NMR spectra for compound 44 (Structure 1007b herein).
  • FIG. 6 shows 1 H NMR spectra for Compound 47 (Structure 1027b herein).
  • the aryl bromide 49 (4.2 g, 11.6 mmol) and boronic acid 50 (2.8 g, 12.2 mmol) were dissolved in a 1:1 mixture of DMF/water (168 mL) and degassed for 10 minutes.
  • the solution was treated with potassium carbonate (8.0 g, 116.2 mmol) and PdCl2 (dppf) (0.476 g, 0.6 mmol) and the reaction vessel was placed under nitrogen atmosphere and heated to 40° C. for 5 hours.
  • the pH was adjusted to 12 and the aqueous phase was washed 2 ⁇ (20 mL) ethyl acetate.
  • the pH was then adjusted to 1.75-2.00 and cooled to 15° C.
  • the resulting solids were filtered and washed with water several times to remove any inorganics to provide 51 (4.8 g, 89% yield).
  • the benzyl-protected alcohol 54 (2.0 g, 1.08 mmol) was dissolved in ethanol (23 mL) and placed under nitrogen atmosphere. To the solution was added 10%/Pd/C (0.7 g, 30 mol %). The slurry was stirred for 8 hours at ambient and the catalyst was removed via celite pad. The organics were removed under high vacuum resulting in a white solid 55 (1.4 g, 74% yield).
  • Compound 56 of Example 7 is Structure 1026b herein.
  • FIG. 7 is a photograph illustrating the behavior of a GalNAc structure having the same targeting moiety (N-acetyl-galactosamine), tether, and branch point group as Structure 1008b, but includes a PEG linker instead of the rigid linker of Structure 1008b disclosed herein.
  • the PEG linker-GalNAc phosphoramidite compound was held for 12 hours in a 3:1 mixture of ACN:DMF at 0.1 M dilution over molecular sieves.
  • the PEG linker-GalNAc shows significant gelling in this highly polar solvent system. For this PEG linker-GalNAc phosphoramidite compound, it is necessary to use up to 1:1 mixture of ACN:DMF to maintain solubility.
  • FIG. 8 Attached at FIG. 8 is a photograph depicting phosphoramidite compound Structure 1008b being fully dissolved in 0.05 M in acetonitrile, without the need for a highly polar solvent such as DMF.
  • the phosphoramidite compounds that include the rigid linker of Structure 1008b are not at risk or require a highly polar solvent to maintain solubility.
  • this illustrates that the structures comprising the rigid linkers disclosed herein are more soluble in common solvents typically used for oligonucleotide synthesis, and do not require the addition of a highly polar solvent to prevent gelling.
  • FIG. 2A shows a 31 P NMR spectra of the phosphoramidite compound of Structure 1008b.
  • FIG. 2A shows a single peak exhibiting the correct shift for phosphoramidite. No other peaks, including hydrolysis peaks, are shown, which indicate a highly pure compound.
  • FIG. 9 shows a 31 P NMR spectra of a PEG linker-GalNAc Structure, that otherwise includes the same branch point, tether, and targeting moiety as Structure 1008b.
  • the chemical structure of the phosphoramidite for which the spectra of FIG. 9 was obtained is depicted on FIG. 9 .
  • FIG. 9 shows multiple impurity peaks, which include what appear to be hydrolyzed by-product.
  • RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis. Depending on the scale, either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation) was used. Syntheses were performed on a solid support made of controlled pore glass (CPG, 500 ⁇ or 600 ⁇ , obtained from Prime Synthesis, Aston, Pa., USA). All RNA and 2′-modified RNA phosphoramidites were purchased from Thermo Fisher Scientific (Milwaukee, Wis., USA).
  • the 2′-deoxy-2′-fluoro-phosphoramidites carried the same protecting groups as the 2′-O-methyl RNA amidites.
  • Targeting ligand containing phosphoramidites were dissolved in anhydrous dichloromethane or anhydrous acetonitrile (50 mM), while all other amidites were dissolved in anhydrous acetonitrile (50 mM) and molecular sieves (3 ⁇ ) were added.
  • 5-Benzylthio-1H-tetrazole (BTT, 250 mM in acetonitrile) or 5-Ethylthio-1H-tetrazole (ETT, 250 mM in acetonitrile) was used as activator solution.
  • RNAi agents were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the RNAi agents. This solution was placed into a thermomixer at 70° C., heated to 95° C., held at 95° C. for 5 min, and cooled to room temperature slowly. Some RNAi agents were lyophilized and stored at ⁇ 15 to ⁇ 25° C. Duplex concentration was determined by measuring the solution absorbance on a UV-Vis spectrometer in 0.2 ⁇ PBS.
  • the solution absorbance at 260 nm was then multiplied by a conversion factor and the dilution factor to determine the duplex concentration. Unless otherwise stated, all conversion factor was 0.037 mg/(mL cm). For some experiments, a conversion factor was calculated from an experimentally determined extinction coefficient.
  • F12 RNAi agents double-stranded RNAi agents directed to F12
  • Each strand of the F12 RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • the F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands i.e., (NAG15) or (NAG18) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • the F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 3 mg/kg (mpk) dose of one of two F12 RNAi agents (AD02803 or AD02807) in buffered saline.
  • AD02803 includes (NAG15) attached to the 3′ terminal end of the sense strand
  • AD 2807 includes (NAG18) attached to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand.
  • mice Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days 8, 15, 22 and 29 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating mouse F12 protein (mF12) levels in serum by an internally developed mF12 alphaLISA® (Perkin Elmer). Expression at a specific bleed date was normalized to the mean of the saline control group for that same date.
  • mF12 circulating mouse F12 protein
  • FIG. 10 shows the results from this study.
  • AD02803 showed approximately 70% reduction in circulating F12 levels, while AD02807 showed a greater than 80% reduction.
  • the data also show a difference in length of knockdown effect, as at day 29 AD02803-treated mice showed a faster return to baseline as compared to AD2807-treated mice.
  • compositions directed to the F12 gene were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 2:
  • RNAi agent duplexes of Example 12.
  • Each strand of the F12RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomiation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • the F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligand i.e., (NAG20) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • the F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligand (i.e., (NAG20)) were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 3 mg/kg (mpk) dose of one of the two RNAi agents (AD02815 or AD02816) in buffered saline.
  • mpk 3 mg/kg
  • mice Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days 8, 15, 22 and 29 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating mouse F12 protein (mF12) levels in serum by an internally developed mF12 alphaLISA® (Perkin Elmer). Expression at a specific bleed date was normalized to the mean of the saline control group for that same date.
  • mF12 circulating mouse F12 protein
  • FIG. 11 shows the results from this experiment.
  • AD02816 showed approximately 60% reduction in circulating F12 protein levels, while AD02815 showed a 79% reduction.
  • the data also show a difference in length of knockdown effect.
  • AD02816-treated mice show 40% knockdown while AD02815-treated mice show 71% knockdown from saline levels.
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds double-stranded Lp(a) RNAi agents were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 3:
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • Lp(a) transgenic mice (Frazer K A et al 1995, Nature Genetics 9:424-431) were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • This mouse expresses human apo(a) from a YAC containing the full LPA gene (encoding apo(a) protein) with additional sequences both 5′ and 3′, as well as the human apoB-100, thereby producing humanized Lp(a) particles (hereinafter referred to as “Lp(a) Tg mice.”) (Callow M J et al 1994, PNAS 91:2130-2134).
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands i.e., (NAG25) or (NAG29)
  • SC subcutaneous
  • the Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25) or (NAG29)) at the 5′ end of the sense strand were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the respective Lp(a) RNAi agent (AD03547 or AD03549) in buffered saline.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days ⁇ 1 (pre-dose), 5, 11, 16, 22, 29, and 36. Knockdown was determined by calculating circulating Lp(a) particle levels in serum. Lp(a) particle levels were measured on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations.
  • Lp(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-dose level of expression in that animal (in this case at day ⁇ 1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day ⁇ 1.”
  • Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • AD03549 (NAG25) showed 71% knockdown at nadir (day 16), and AD03547 (NAG29) showed 81% knockdown at nadir (day 11). Both triggers showed similar recovery curves after nadir, with less than 26% knockdown on day 36.
  • Example 14 Apo(a) Knockdown in apo(a) Transgenic (Tg) Mice Following Administration of Lp(a) Expression-inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligand Structures 1002 and 1004
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds double-stranded Lp(a) RNAi agents were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 4:
  • (NAG25) has the same chemical structure as shown in Example 13, above.
  • NAG28 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1002 herein.
  • (NAG30) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1004 herein.
  • (NAG28) includes a mixture of the cis- and trans-isomers, while (NAG30) is exclusively the trans-isomer.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • Apo(a) transgenic (Tg) mice were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • Apo(a) Tg mice express human apo(a) from a YAC containing the full LPA gene (encoding apo(a) protein) with additional sequences both 5′ and 3′ (hereinafter referred to as “apo(a) Tg mice”).
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands i.e., (NAG25), (NAG28), or (NAG30)
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • the Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25), (NAG28), or (NAG30)) at the 5′ end of the sense strand were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 0.5 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the RNAi agent (AD03536, AD03538, or AD03540) in buffered saline.
  • mpk 0.5 mg/kg
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days ⁇ 1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, and 29. Knockdown was determined by assaying serum from the mice using an ELISA for apo(a) (Abcam).
  • apo(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal (in this case at day ⁇ 1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day ⁇ 1”.
  • Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group.
  • Experimental error is given as standard error of the mean.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 13 .
  • Nadir was day 15 for all RNAi agents tested.
  • AD03536 showed 74% knockdown of apo(a) protein
  • AD03538 showed 74% knockdown of apo(a) protein
  • AD03540 showed 71% knockdown of apo(a) protein.
  • all of the RNAi agents show >48% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels except for AD03536 (containing NAG25) which shows only 16% knockdown.
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds double-stranded Lp(a) RNAi agents were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 5:
  • (NAG25) is the same structure as shown in Example 13, above.
  • NAG31 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1005 herein.
  • NAG37 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1008 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • Lp(a) Tg mice were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands i.e., (NAG25), (NAG31) or (NAG37)
  • SC subcutaneous
  • the Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 3 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the RNAi agent (AD03536, AD03629, or AD04170) in buffered saline.
  • mpk 3 mg/kg
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days ⁇ 1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, 29, and 36. Knockdown was determined by calculating circulating Lp(a) particle levels in serum. Lp(a) particle levels were measured on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations.
  • Lp(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-dose level of expression in that animal (in this case at day ⁇ 1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day ⁇ 1.”
  • Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • AD03536 showed 95% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir (day 15), and maintained knockdown of 76% at day 36.
  • AD03629 showed 97% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir (day 8), and maintained knockdown of 90% at day 36.
  • AD04170 showed 97% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir (day 8), and maintained knockdown of 78% at day 36.
  • Example 16 F12 Knockdown in Wild Type Mice Following Administration of F12 Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structures 1005, 1008, 1025, and 1027
  • F12 expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded F12 RNAi agents) were prepared that were conjugated at the 5′ terminal end via a phosphorothioate linkage to GalNAc targeting ligands (NAG25)s [AD04162]; (NAG37)s [AD04623]; (NAG31)s [AD04512]; (NAG33)s [AD04650] or (NAG38)s [AD04651].
  • Each of the double-stranded RNAi agents were directed to F12.
  • NAG31 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1005 herein.
  • (NAG33)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1025 herein.
  • (NAG37)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1008 herein.
  • (NAG38)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1027 herein.
  • the sequences and modification patterns were identical for AD04162, AD04623, AD04512, AD04650, and AD04651, with the only difference in the compositions being the GalNAc targeting ligand structure located at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of each F12 RNAi agent, as shown above.
  • Each strand of the F12 RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • the F12 RNAi agents conjugated to the respective GalNAc targeting ligands i.e., (NAG25)s, (NAG31)s, (NAG33)s, (NAG37)s, or (NAG38)s
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • the F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ul solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of one of five duplexes (AD04162, AD04623, AD04512, AD04650 and AD04651) in buffered saline.
  • mpk 1 mg/kg
  • AD04162 includes the structure (NAG25)s
  • AD04623 includes the structure (NAG37)s
  • AD04512 includes the structure (NAG31)s
  • AD04650 includes the structure (NAG33)s
  • AD04651 includes the structure (NAG38)s. All GalNAc targeting ligands were attached at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of each respective RNAi agent
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days ⁇ 1 (pre-dose), 8, 15 and 22 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating mouse F12 protein (mF12) levels in serum by an internally developed mF12 alphaLISA® (Perkin Elmer). mF12 levels for each animal at a respective time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to pre-dose”. Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day pre-dose” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day pre-dose” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • results from this study are shown in FIG. 15 .
  • Nadir was day 8 for all RNAi agents tested.
  • AD04162 showed 90% knockdown of mF12
  • AD04623 showed 94% knockdown of mF12
  • AD04512 showed 94% knockdown of mF12
  • AD04650 showed 92% knockdown of mF12
  • AD04651 showed 87% knockdown at of mF12.
  • all of the RNAi agents show >82% knockdown of mF12 levels except for AD04162 (containing NAG25) which shows only 74% knockdown.
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 6:
  • NAG30 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1004 herein.
  • NAG31 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1005 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramiidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomiation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • Lp(a) Tg mice as described herein were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands i.e., NAG30 or NAG31
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • the Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., NAG30 or NAG31) at the 5′ end of the sense strand were delivered via SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the Lp(a) RNAi agent (AD03629 or AD03540) in buffered saline.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days ⁇ 1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, 29, 36 and 43. Knockdown was determined by calculating circulating Lp(a) particle levels in serum. Lp(a) particle levels were measured on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations.
  • Lp(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-dose level of expression in that animal (in this case at day ⁇ 1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day ⁇ 1.”
  • Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 16 .
  • Nadir was day 15 for both RNAi agents studied.
  • AD03629 showed 89% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir, while AD03540 showed 85% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir.
  • Both RNAi agents showed similar recovery curves to day 36.
  • AD03540 showed 16% knockdown of Lp(a) levels
  • AD03629 showed 55% knockdown of Lp(a) levels.
  • Example 18 Apo(a) Knockdown in apo(a) Tg Mice Following Administration of Lp(a) Expression-inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds Linked to Targeting Ligand Structures 1007, 1025, and 1026
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 7:
  • NAG33 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1025 herein.
  • NAG34 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1026 herein.
  • NAG35 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1007 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • Apo(a) transgenic (Tg) mice were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands i.e., NAG33, NAG34 or NAG35
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents conjugated to the respective GalNAc targeting ligands were administered by SC injection.
  • a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the RNAi agent (AD03721, AD03722, or AD03723) in buffered saline.
  • mpk 1 mg/kg
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days ⁇ 1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, and 29. Knockdown was determined by assaying circulating apo(a) protein levels in serum. Human apo(a) protein levels in serum were monitored by assaying serum from the mice using an ELISA for apo(a) (Abcam). For normalization, apo(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal (in this case at day ⁇ 1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day ⁇ 1”.
  • Resulting data are shown in FIG. 17 .
  • AD03721 showed 91% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels at nadir
  • AD03722 showed 81% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels at nadir
  • AD03723 showed 90% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels at nadir.
  • Recovery of apo(a) protein levels after treatment showed similar trajectories, with both AD03721 and AD03723-treated mice showing nearly identical knockdown at each timepoint, whereas AD03722-treated mice showed numerically less knockdown at each timepoint tested.
  • AD03721-treated mice showed 76% knockdown of apo(a) levels
  • AD03723-treated mice showed 83% knockdown of apo(a) levels
  • AD03722-treated mice showed 61% knockdown of apo(a) levels.
  • Example 19 Dose Response of LP(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structure 1008, Dosed at 1 mg/kg and 3 Mg/Kg in Lp(a) Tg Mice
  • Lp(a) transgenic mice as described herein were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • RNAi agents directed to Lp(a) having Duplex ID: AD04170, as set forth above in Example 15, were manufactured.
  • Lp(a) Duplex ID: AD04170 includes a (NAG37) targeting ligand (Structure 1008) attached at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • the Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to targeting ligand Structure 1008 were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • the Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to targeting ligand Structure 1008 were administered by subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • SC subcutaneous
  • a SC injection was made into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ⁇ l solution/20 g mouse containing a dose of either saline, 1 mg/kg (mpk) of the RNAi agent in buffered saline, or 3 mg/kg (mpk) of the RNAi agent in buffered saline.
  • Control serum (pre-treatment) samples were taken from the mice pre-injection on day ⁇ 1.
  • Lp(a) particle levels were determined on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations.
  • Lp(a) levels for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal (in this case at day ⁇ 1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day ⁇ 1.”
  • Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day ⁇ 1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 18 . As shown in FIG. 18 , a dose-dependent relationship is apparent for the Lp(a) RNAi agent across all time points.
  • Example 20 LP(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structures 1003 and 1004 in Cynomolgus Monkeys
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 8:
  • Lp(a) RNAi agent AD03547 is the same as shown in Example 13, and is conjugated to (NAG29).
  • Lp(a) RNAi agent AD3668 was conjugated to (NAG30).
  • (NAG30) has the chemical structure shown in Example 14.
  • (NAG29) is represented by Structure 1003 herein.
  • (NAG30) is represented by Structure 1004 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2 ⁇ PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • PBS Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1 ⁇ , Corning, Cellgro
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents conjugated to targeting ligands disclosed herein having Structure 1003 or Structure 1004 were made and combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SQ) injection.
  • Control serum (pre-treatment) samples were taken from the cynomolgus monkeys pre-injection on day ⁇ 14, ⁇ 7, and day 1 (pre-dose).
  • Lp(a) particle levels were determined on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations. For normalization, Lp(a) levels for each animal at a time point was divided by the average of the pre-treatment levels of expression in that animal (in this case at days ⁇ 14, ⁇ 7, and day 1 (pre-dose)) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to pre-dose.” Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • cynomolgus macaque Macaca fascicularis ) primates were injected subcutaneously with Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to targeting ligands disclosed herein with 3 mg/kg of either Lp(a) RNAi agent AD03668 or Lp(a) RNAi agent AD03547. Two (2) monkeys were dosed per treatment group.
  • Example 21 F12 Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structure 1008 in Cynomolgus Monkeys
  • F12 RNAi agents having varying sequences directed to F12 and linked to GalNAc targeting ligand Structure 1008 [(NAG37)s] at the 5′ end of the sense strand, were made and combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • (NAG37)s has the chemical structure as shown in Example 16, above.
  • cynomolgus macaque Macaca fascicularis
  • primates were injected subcutaneously with 3 mg/kg of one of six (6) different Lp(a) RNAi agents having different sequence structures and different modification patterns: AD04623, AD04624, AD04625, AD04626, AD04627, or AD04628.
  • Two (2) monkeys were dosed per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated cynomolgus monkeys were taken on day ⁇ 7 and day 1 (pre-dose), and on days 8, 15 and 22 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating cyno F12 protein (cF12) levels in serum by a human F12 ELISA kit (Molecular Innovations). cF12 levels for each animal at a respective time point was divided by the pre-treatment level (average of day ⁇ 7 and day 1) of expression in that animal to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to pre-dose”. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • FIG. 20 shows the results.
  • Each of the F12 RNAi agents linked to NAG37 (Structure 1008) showed knockdown in cynomolgus monkeys, with AD04625 and AD04623 showing the greatest knockdown across all time points measured.
  • RNAi agents directed to the alpha-1 antitrypsin (AAT) gene were used in vivo.
  • PiZ mice harbor the human PiZ AAT mutant allele and model human AATD (Carlson et al., Journal of Clinical Investigation 1989).
  • AAT expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds double stranded RNAi agents were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 9:
  • RNAi agent duplexes RNAi agent duplexes
  • Plasma samples were drawn and analyzed for AAT (Z-AAT) protein levels on days ⁇ 1, day 1 (pre-dose), day 8, and day 15. AAT levels were normalized to day 1 (pre-dose) AAT plasma levels. Protein levels were measured by quantifying circulating human Z-AAT levels in plasma by an ELISA kit.
  • the average normalized AAT (Z-AAT) levels are shown in FIG. 21 .
  • the AAT RNAi agent linked to the targeting ligand of Structure 1008 herein showed knockdown in PiZ transgenic mice.

Abstract

Described are novel targeting ligands that may be linked to compounds, such therapeutic compounds that are useful in directing the compounds to the in vivo target. The targeting ligands disclosed herein can serve to target expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, such as RNAi agents, to liver cells to modulate gene expression. The targeting ligands disclosed herein, when conjugated to a therapeutic compound, may be used in a variety of applications, including use in therapeutic, diagnostic, target validation, and genomic discovery applications. Compositions including the targeting ligands disclosed herein when linked to expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds are capable of mediating expression of target nucleic acid sequences in liver cells, such as hepatocytes, which may be useful in the treatment of diseases or conditions that respond to inhibition of gene expression or activity in a cell, tissue, or organism.

Description

    CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 16/380,695, filed on Apr. 10, 2021 which claims priority to U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/452,324, filed on Mar. 7, 2017, which claims priority to U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 62/383,221, filed on Sep. 2, 2016, and U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 62/456,339, filed on Feb. 8, 2017, the contents of each of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • SEQUENCE LISTING
  • This application incorporates by reference in its entirety the Sequence Listing entitled “Sequence_Listing_30641” (7.28 kilobytes), which was created Sep. 14, 2021 and filed electronically herewith.
  • BACKGROUND
  • Many compounds need to be delivered to a specific location (for example, to desired cell(s)) to have a therapeutic effect or to be useful for diagnostic purposes. This is frequently the case when attempting to deliver a therapeutic compound in vivo. Further, being able to efficiently deliver a compound to a specific location can limit or potentially eliminate unintended consequences (such as off-target effects) that may be caused by administration of the compound. One method to facilitate delivery of a compound, such as a therapeutic compound, to a desired location in vivo, is by linking or attaching the compound to a targeting ligand.
  • One class of therapeutic compounds that can be targeted using targeting ligands are oligomeric compounds. Oligomeric compounds that include nucleotide sequences at least partially complementary to a target nucleic acid have been shown to alter the function and activity of the target both in vitro and in vivo. When delivered to a cell containing a target nucleic acid (such as mRNA), oligomeric compounds have been shown to modulate the expression of the target resulting in altered transcription or translation of the target nucleic acid. In certain instances, the oligomeric compound can reduce the expression of the gene by inhibiting the nucleic acid target and/or triggering the degradation of the target nucleic acid.
  • If the target nucleic acid is mRNA, one mechanism by which an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can modulate the expression of the mRNA target is through RNA interference. RNA interference is a biological process by which RNA or RNA-like molecules (such as chemically modified RNA molecules) are able to silence gene expression through degradation. The process of post-transcriptional gene silencing is thought to be an evolutionarily-conserved cellular defense mechanism used to prevent the expression of foreign genes.
  • Synthetic RNA and RNA-like molecules have been shown to elicit RNA interference in vivo. For example, Elbashir et al. (Nature 2000, 411, 494-98) describes RNAi induced by introduction of duplexes of synthetic 21-nucleotide RNA molecules in cultured mammalian cells. The types of synthetic RNA or RNA-like molecules that can trigger the RNAi response mechanism may be comprised of modified nucleotides and/or one or more non-phosphodiester linkages.
  • Additionally, single-stranded RNA and RNA-like molecules, which can also include modified nucleotides and have one or more non-phosphodiester linkages, can also alter the expression of a target nucleic acid, such as a target mRNA.
  • SUMMARY
  • Disclosed herein are targeting ligands that can enhance the delivery of therapeutic compounds to a specific target site, e.g., a specific organ or tissue, within a subject such as a human patient or animal. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands described herein can enhance the targeted delivery of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands can enhance the delivery of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds to the liver.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein include, consist of, or consist essentially of one or more targeting moieties, one or more tethers, one or more branch point groups, and one or more linkers. Linkers suitable for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein include a “rigid” linker, which can impart sufficient stability and rigidity to the overall targeting ligand to reduce potential interaction between one or more of the targeting moiety(ies) and the therapeutic compound to which it is or they are linked. Additionally, the “rigid” linkers suitable for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein are useful in efficiently synthesizing the targeting ligands as phosphoramidite compounds (also referred to herein as “phosphoramidite-containing compounds”).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein include, consist of, or consist essentially of one or more targeting moieties, one or more tethers, and one or more branch point groups with a linker replacement moiety. The linker replacement moiety includes, consists of, or consists essentially of, one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl groups, or covalently linked combinations thereof, located within the branch point group. Having a linker replacement moiety within the branch point group confers properties similar to those of the “rigid” linkers disclosed herein, by providing sufficient stability and rigidity to the overall targeting ligand. Additionally, the branch point groups with linker replacement moieties suitable for use in the targeting ligands are useful in efficiently synthesizing the targeting ligands as phosphoramidite compounds.
  • Disclosed herein are targeting ligands comprising, consisting of, or consisting essentially of a structure of Formula I, as shown in FIG. 22,
  • comprising a linker, a branch point group, one or more tethers, and one or more targeting moieties, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4), and wherein the linker is a structure selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00001
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00002
  • wherein n′ is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10, and when present, each Z′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure 7);
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00003
  • wherein n″ is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4), and when present, each Z″ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure 8); and
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00004
  • wherein V comprises one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), or substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.), or any covalently linked combination thereof. (Structure 9).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands include a branch point group with a linker replacement moiety.
  • Disclosed herein are targeting ligands comprising, consisting of, or consisting essentially of a structure of Formula II, as shown in FIG. 23,
  • comprising a branch point group with linker replacement moiety, one or more tethers, and one or more targeting moieties, wherein n is an integer between 1 and 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4), and wherein the linker replacement moiety includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), or substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.), or any covalently linked combination thereof, is located within the branch point group.
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein can be linked, directly or indirectly, to a compound, such as a therapeutic compound, e.g., an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, for example, to the 3′ or 5′ terminal end of the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound includes one or more modified nucleotides. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent, such as a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein are linked to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein are linked to the RNAi agent via a phosphate, phosphorothioate, or phosphonate group at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein include one or more targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein include N-acetyl-galactosamine as the targeting moiety.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein have structures represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00005
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00006
  • Disclosed herein are compositions including, consisting of, or consisting essentially of, a targeting ligand and an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. Disclosed herein are compositions including a targeting ligand and an RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, the compositions disclosed herein including a targeting ligand and an RNAi agent have the structure represented by:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00007
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1002a);
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00008
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1003a);
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00009
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1005a);
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00010
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1008a);
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00011
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1012a); or
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00012
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1027a).
  • Disclosed herein are phosphoramidite compounds including targeting ligands.
  • In some embodiments, the phosphoramidite compounds including targeting ligands disclosed herein have the structure represented by:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00013
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00014
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00015
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00016
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00017
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00018
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00019
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00020
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00021
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00022
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00023
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00024
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00025
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00026
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00027
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00028
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00029
  • Also disclosed are pharmaceutical compositions that include the targeting ligands disclosed herein.
  • Disclosed are methods of treating a disease or disorder that would benefit from administration of a compound, the methods including administering to a subject a compound linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein.
  • Disclosed herein are methods of inhibiting expression of a target nucleic acid in a subject, the methods including administering a therapeutic amount of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to the targeting ligands disclosed herein.
  • Disclosed herein are methods of delivering an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound to the liver in vivo, comprising administering an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein to a subject.
  • Disclosed herein are processes or methods of manufacturing a phosphoramidite compound including a targeting ligand, the method comprising (i) covalently linking the linker to the branch point group, and (ii) linking the linker to a phosphorus atom of a phosphoramidite through a phosphytylation reaction with a phosphoramidite forming reagent, thereby forming a phosphoramidite compound.
  • As used herein, the term “linked” when referring to the connection between two molecules means that two molecules are joined by a covalent bond or that two molecules are associated via noncovalent bonds (e.g., hydrogen bonds or ionic bonds). In some examples, where the term “linked” refers to the association between two molecules via noncovalent bonds, the association between the two different molecules has a KD of less than 1×10−4 M (e.g., less than 1×10−5 M, less than 1×10−6 M, or less than 1×10−7 M) in physiologically acceptable buffer (e.g., phosphate buffered saline).
  • As used herein, the term “directly linked” refers to a first compound or group being linked to a second compound or group without any intervening atoms or groups of atoms. As used herein, the term “indirectly linked” refers to a first compound being linked to a second compound or group through an intermediary group, compound, or molecule, such as, for example, a linking group. Unless otherwise stated, the term “linked” as used herein includes both “directly linked” and “indirectly linked” as those terms are defined herein.
  • As used herein, an “oligomeric compound” is a nucleotide sequence containing about 10-50 nucleotides or nucleotide base pairs. In some embodiments, an oligomeric compound has a nucleobase sequence that is at least partially complementary to a coding sequence in an expressed target nucleic acid or target gene within a cell. In some embodiments, the oligomeric compounds, upon delivery to a cell expressing a gene, are able to inhibit the expression of the underlying gene, and are referred to herein as “expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds.” The gene expression can be inhibited in vitro or in vivo. “Oligomeric compounds” include, but are not limited to: oligonucleotides, single-stranded oligonucleotides, single-stranded antisense oligonucleotides, short interfering RNAs (siRNAs), double-strand RNAs (dsRNA), micro RNAs (miRNAs), short hairpin RNAs (shRNA), ribozymes, interfering RNA molecules, and dicer substrates.
  • As used herein, the term “oligonucleotide” means a polymer of linked nucleosides each of which can be independently modified or unmodified.
  • As used herein, the term “single-stranded oligonucleotide” means a single-stranded oligomeric compound having a sequence at least partially complementary to a target mRNA, that is capable of hybridizing to a target mRNA through hydrogen bonding under mammalian physiological conditions (or comparable conditions in vitro). In some embodiments, a single-stranded oligonucleotide is a single stranded antisense oligonucleotide.
  • As used herein, an “RNAi agent” means an agent that contains an RNA or RNA-like (e.g., chemically modified RNA) oligonucleotide molecule that is capable of degrading or inhibiting translation of messenger RNA (mRNA) transcripts of a target mRNA in a sequence specific manner. As used herein, RNAi agents may operate through the RNA interference mechanism (i.e., inducing RNA interference through interaction with the RNA interference pathway machinery (RNA-induced silencing complex or RISC) of mammalian cells), or by any alternative mechanism(s) or pathway(s). While it is believed that RNAi agents, as that term is used herein, operate primarily through the RNA interference mechanism, the disclosed RNAi agents are not bound by or limited to any particular pathway or mechanism of action. RNAi agents include, but are not limited to: single-stranded oligonucleotides, single-stranded antisense oligonucleotides, short interfering RNAs (siRNAs), double-strand RNAs (dsRNA), micro RNAs (miRNAs), short hairpin RNAs (shRNA), and dicer substrates. The RNAi agents described herein are comprised of an oligonucleotide having a strand that is at least partially complementary to the mRNA being targeted. In some embodiments, the RNAi agents described herein are double-stranded, and are comprised of an antisense strand and a sense strand that is at least partially complementary to the antisense strand. RNAi agents may be comprised of modified nucleotides and/or one or more non-phosphodiester linkages. In some embodiments, the RNAi agents described herein are single-stranded.
  • As used herein, the terms “silence,” “reduce,” “inhibit,” “down-regulate,” or “knockdown” when referring to expression of a given gene, mean that the expression of the gene, as measured by the level of RNA transcribed from the gene or the level of polypeptide, protein or protein subunit translated from the mRNA in a cell, group of cells, tissue, organ, or subject in which the gene is transcribed, is reduced when the cell, group of cells, tissue, organ, or subject is treated with oligomeric compounds linked to the targeting ligands described herein as compared to a second cell, group of cells, tissue, organ, or subject that has not or have not been so treated.
  • As used herein, the term “sequence” or “nucleotide sequence” mean a succession or order of nucleobases or nucleotides, described with a succession of letters using the standard nucleotide nomenclature.
  • As used herein, and unless otherwise indicated, the term “complementary,” when used to describe a first nucleotide sequence (e.g., RNAi agent sense strand or targeted mRNA) in relation to a second nucleotide sequence (e.g., single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide or a double-stranded RNAi agent antisense strand), means the ability of an oligonucleotide or polynucleotide including the first nucleotide sequence to hybridize (form base pair hydrogen bonds under mammalian physiological conditions (or comparable conditions in vitro)) and form a duplex or double helical structure under certain conditions with an oligonucleotide or polynucleotide including the second nucleotide sequence. Complementary sequences include Watson-Crick base pairs or non-Watson-Crick base pairs and include natural or modified nucleotides or nucleotide mimics, at least to the extent that the above requirements with respect to the ability to hybridize are fulfilled.
  • As used herein, “perfectly complementary” or “fully complementary” means that all (100%) of the bases in a contiguous sequence of a first polynucleotide will hybridize with the same number of bases in a contiguous sequence of a second polynucleotide. The contiguous sequence may comprise all or a part of a first or second nucleotide sequence.
  • As used herein, “partially complementary” means that in a hybridized pair of nucleobase sequences, at least 70%, but not all, of the bases in a contiguous sequence of a first polynucleotide will hybridize with the same number of bases in a contiguous sequence of a second polynucleotide.
  • As used herein, “substantially complementary” means that in a hybridized pair of nucleobase sequences, at least 85%, but not all, of the bases in a contiguous sequence of a first polynucleotide will hybridize with the same number of bases in a contiguous sequence of a second polynucleotide. The terms “complementary,” “fully complementary,” and “substantially complementary” herein may be used with respect to the base matching between the sense strand and the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent, between the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent and a sequence of a target mRNA, or between a single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide and a sequence of a target mRNA.
  • As used herein, the terms “treat,” “treatment,” and the like, mean the methods or steps taken to provide relief from or alleviation of the number, severity, and/or frequency of one or more symptoms of a disease in a subject.
  • As used herein, the phrase “introducing into a cell,” when referring to an oligomeric compound, means functionally delivering the oligomeric compound into a cell. The phrase “functional delivery,” means that delivering the oligomeric compound to the cell in a manner that enables the oligomeric compound to have the expected biological activity, e.g., sequence-specific inhibition of gene expression.
  • Unless stated otherwise, use of the symbol
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00030
  • as used herein means that any group or groups may be linked thereto that is in accordance with the scope of the inventions described herein.
  • As used herein, the term “isomers” refers to compounds that have identical molecular formulae, but that differ in the nature or the sequence of bonding of their atoms or in the arrangement of their atoms in space. Isomers that differ in the arrangement of their atoms in space are termed “stereoisomers.” Stereoisomers that are not mirror images of one another are termed “diastereoisomers,” and stereoisomers that are non-superimposable mirror images are termed “enantiomers,” or sometimes optical isomers. A carbon atom bonded to four non-identical substituents is termed a “chiral center.”
  • As used herein, unless specifically identified in a structure as having a particular conformation, for each structure in which asymmetric centers are present and thus give rise to enantiomers, diastereomers, or other stereoisomeric configurations, each structure disclosed herein is intended to represent all such possible isomers, including their optically pure and racemic forms. For example, the structures disclosed herein are intended to cover mixtures of diastereomers as well as single stereoisomers.
  • The term “substituted,” as used herein, means that any one or more hydrogens on the designated atom, usually a carbon, oxygen, or nitrogen atom, is replaced with any group as defined herein, provided that the designated atom's normal valency is not exceeded, and that the substitution results in a stable compound. Non-limiting examples of substituents include C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, cyano, hydroxyl, oxo, carboxyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, aryl, keto, alkoxycarbonyl, aryloxycarbonyl, heteroaryloxycarbonyl, or halo (e.g., F, Cl, Br, I). When a substituent is keto or oxo (i.e., ═O), then two (2) hydrogens on the atom are replaced. Ring double bonds, as used herein, are double bonds that are formed between two adjacent ring atoms (e.g., C═C, C═N, N═N, etc.).
  • Some compounds of the present disclosure can exist in a tautomeric form that is also intended to be encompassed within the scope of the present disclosure. “Tautomers” are compounds whose structures differ markedly in the arrangement of atoms, but which exist in easy and rapid equilibrium. It is to be understood that compounds of the present disclosure may be depicted as different tautomers. It should also be understood that when compounds have tautomeric forms, all tautomeric forms are intended to be within the scope of the disclosure, and the naming of the compounds does not exclude any tautomeric form.
  • The compounds and pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the present disclosure can exist in one or more tautomeric forms, including ketone—enol, amide—nitrile, lactam—lactim, amide—imidic acid tautomerism in heterocyclic rings (e.g., in the nucleobases guanine, thymine, and cytosine), amine—enamine and enamine—enamine and geometric isomers and mixtures thereof. Ring-chain tautomerism, exhibited by glucose and other sugars, arises as a result of the aldehyde group (—CHO) in a sugar chain molecule reacting with one of the hydroxy groups (—OH) in the same molecule to give it a cyclic (ring-shaped) form. All such tautomeric forms are included within the scope of the present disclosure. Tautomers exist as mixtures of a tautomeric set in solution. In solid form, usually one tautomer predominates. Even though one tautomer may be described, the present disclosure includes all tautomers of the compounds disclosed herein. The concept of tautomers that are interconvertible by tautomerizations is called tautomerism. In tautomerism, a simultaneous shift of electrons and a hydrogen atom occurs.
  • Tautomerizations are catalyzed by: Base: 1. deprotonation; 2. formation of a delocalized anion (e.g. an enolate); 3. protonation at a different position of the anion; Acid: 1. protonation; 2. formation of a delocalized cation; 3. deprotonation at a different position adjacent to the cation.
  • As used herein, the term “alkyl” refers to a saturated aliphatic hydrocarbon group, straight chain or branched, having from 1 to 10 carbon atoms unless otherwise specified. For example, “C1-C6 alkyl” includes alkyl groups having 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 carbons in a linear or branched arrangement. As used herein, the term “aminoalkyl” refers to an alkyl group as defined above, substituted at any position with one or more amino groups as permitted by normal valency. The amino groups may be unsubstituted, monosubstituted, or di-substituted.
  • As used herein, the term “cycloalkyl” means a saturated or unsaturated nonaromatic hydrocarbon ring group having from 3 to 14 carbon atoms, unless otherwise specified. Examples of cycloalkyl groups include, but are not limited to, cyclopropyl, methyl-cyclopropyl, 2,2-dimethyl-cyclobutyl, 2-ethyl-cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, etc. Cycloalkyls may include multiple spiro- or fused rings. Cycloalkyl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • As used herein, the term “alkenyl” refers to a non-aromatic hydrocarbon radical, straight or branched, containing at least one carbon-carbon double bond, and having from 2 to 10 carbon atoms unless otherwise specified. Up to five carbon-carbon double bonds may be present in such groups. For example, “C2-C6” alkenyl is defined as an alkenyl radical having from 2 to 6 carbon atoms. Examples of alkenyl groups include, but are not limited to, ethenyl, propenyl, butenyl, and cyclohexenyl. The straight, branched, or cyclic portion of the alkenyl group may contain double bonds and is optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency. The term “cycloalkenyl” means a monocyclic hydrocarbon group having the specified number of carbon atoms and at least one carbon-carbon double bond.
  • As used herein, the term “alkynyl” refers to a hydrocarbon radical, straight or branched, containing from 2 to 10 carbon atoms, unless otherwise specified, and containing at least one carbon-carbon triple bond. Up to 5 carbon-carbon triple bonds may be present. Thus, “C2-C6 alkynyl” means an alkynyl radical having from 2 to 6 carbon atoms. Examples of alkynyl groups include, but are not limited to, ethynyl, 2-propynyl, and 2-butynyl. The straight or branched portion of the alkynyl group may contain triple bonds as permitted by normal valency, and may be optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • As used herein, “alkoxyl” or “alkoxy” refers to an alkyl group as defined above with the indicated number of carbon atoms attached through an oxygen bridge. C1-6 alkoxy, is intended to include C1, C2, C3, C4, C5, and C6 alkoxy groups. C1-8alkoxy, is intended to include C1, C2, C3, C4, C5, C6, C7, and C9 alkoxy groups. Examples of alkoxy include, but are not limited to, methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, i-propoxy, n-butoxy, s-butoxy, t-butoxy, n-pentoxy, s-pentoxy, n-heptoxy, and n-octoxy.
  • As used herein, “keto” refers to any alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocyclyl, heteroaryl, or aryl group as defined herein attached through a carbonyl bridge. Examples of keto groups include, but are not limited to, alkanoyl (e.g., acetyl, propionyl, butanoyl, pentanoyl, hexanoyl), alkenoyl (e.g., acryloyl) alkynoyl (e.g., ethynoyl, propynoyl, butynoyl, pentynoyl, hexynoyl), aryloyl (e.g., benzoyl), heteroaryloyl (e.g., pyrroloyl, imidazoloyl, quinolinoyl, pyridinoyl).
  • As used herein, “alkoxycarbonyl” refers to any alkoxy group as defined above attached through a carbonyl bridge (i.e., —C(O)O-alkyl). Examples of alkoxycarbonyl groups include, but are not limited to, methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, iso-propoxycarbonyl, n-propoxycarbonyl, t-butoxycarbonyl, benzyloxycarbonyl or n-pentoxycarbonyl.
  • As used herein, “aryloxycarbonyl” refers to any aryl group as defined herein attached through an oxycarbonyl bridge (i.e., —C(O)O-aryl). Examples of aryloxycarbonyl groups include, but are not limited to, phenoxycarbonyl and naphthyloxycarbonyl.
  • As used herein, “heteroaryloxycarbonyl” refers to any heteroaryl group as defined herein attached through an oxycarbonyl bridge (i.e., —C(O)O-heteroaryl). Examples of heteroaryloxycarbonyl groups include, but are not limited to, 2-pyridyloxycarbonyl, 2-oxazolyloxycarbonyl, 4-thiazolyloxycarbonyl, or pyrimidinyloxycarbonyl.
  • As used herein, “aryl” or “aromatic” means any stable monocyclic or polycyclic carbon ring of up to 7 atoms in each ring, wherein at least one ring is aromatic. Examples of aryl groups include, but are not limited to, phenyl, naphthyl, anthracenyl, tetrahydronaphthyl, indanyl, and biphenyl. In cases where the aryl substituent is bicyclic and one ring is non-aromatic, it is understood that attachment is via the aromatic ring. Aryl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • As used herein, the term “heteroaryl” represents a stable monocyclic or polycyclic ring of up to 7 atoms in each ring, wherein at least one ring is aromatic and contains from 1 to 4 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, N and S. Examples of heteroaryl groups include, but are not limited to, acridinyl, carbazolyl, cinnolinyl, quinoxalinyl, pyrrazolyl, indolyl, benzotriazolyl, furanyl, thienyl, benzothienyl, benzofuranyl, benzimidazolonyl, benzoxazolonyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, dihydroisoindolonyl, imidazopyridinyl, isoindolonyl, indazolyl, oxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, isoxazolyl, indolyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrolyl, tetrahydroquinoline. “Heteroaryl” is also understood to include the N-oxide derivative of any nitrogen-containing heteroaryl. In cases where the heteroaryl substituent is bicyclic and one ring is non-aromatic or contains no heteroatoms, it is understood that attachment is via the aromatic ring or via the heteroatom containing ring. Heteroaryl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • As used herein, the term “heterocycle,” “heterocyclic,” or “heterocyclyl” means a 3- to 14-membered aromatic or nonaromatic heterocycle containing from 1 to 4 heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, N and S, including polycyclic groups. As used herein, the term “heterocyclic” is also considered to be synonymous with the terms “heterocycle” and “heterocyclyl” and is understood as also having the same definitions set forth herein. “Heterocyclyl” includes the above mentioned heteroaryls, as well as dihydro and tetrahydro analogs thereof. Examples of heterocyclyl groups include, but are not limited to, azetidinyl, benzoimidazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzofurazanyl, benzopyrazolyl, benzotriazolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzoxazolyl, carbazolyl, carbolinyl, cinnolinyl, furanyl, imidazolyl, indolinyl, indolyl, indolazinyl, indazolyl, isobenzofuranyl, isoindolyl, isoquinolyl, isothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, naphthpyridinyl, oxadiazolyl, oxooxazolidinyl, oxazolyl, oxazoline, oxopiperazinyl, oxopyrrolidinyl, oxomorpholinyl, isoxazoline, oxetanyl, pyranyl, pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl, pyridazinyl, pyridopyridinyl, pyridazinyl, pyridyl, pyridinonyl, pyrimidyl, pyrimidinonyl, pyrrolyl, quinazolinyl, quinolyl, quinoxalinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, tetrahydroisoquinolinyl, tetrazolyl, tetrazolopyridyl, thiadiazolyl, thiazolyl, thienyl, triazolyl, 1,4-dioxanyl, hexahydroazepinyl, piperazinyl, piperidinyl, pyridin-2-onyl, pyrrolidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, dihydrobenzoimidazolyl, dihydrobenzofuranyl,dihydrobenzothiophenyl, dihydrobenzoxazolyl, dihydrofuranyl, dihydroimidazolyl, dihydroindolyl, dihydroisooxazolyl, dihydroisothiazolyl, dihydrooxadiazolyl, dihydrooxazolyl, dihydropyrazinyl, dihydropyrazolyl, dihydropyridinyl, dihydropyrimidinyl, dihydropyrrolyl, dihydroquinolinyl, dihydrotetrazolyl, dihydrothiadiazolyl, dihydrothiazolyl, dihydrothienyl, dihydrotriazolyl, dihydroazetidinyl, dioxidothiomorpholinyl, methylenedioxybenzoyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, and tetrahydrothienyl, and N-oxides thereof. Attachment of a heterocyclyl substituent can occur via a carbon atom or via a heteroatom. Heterocyclyl groups are optionally mono-, di-, tri-, tetra-, or penta-substituted on any position as permitted by normal valency.
  • The person of ordinary skill in the art would readily understand and appreciate that the compounds and compositions disclosed herein may have certain atoms (e.g., N, O, or S atoms) in a protonated or deprotonated state, depending upon the environment in which the compound or composition is placed. Accordingly, as used herein, the structures disclosed herein envisage that certain functional groups, such as, for example, OH, SH, or NH, may be protonated or deprotonated. The disclosure herein is intended to cover the disclosed compounds and compositions regardless of their state of protonation based on the pH of the environment, as would be readily understood by the person of ordinary skill in the art.
  • As used in a claim herein, the phrase “consisting of” excludes any element, step, or ingredient not specified in the claim. When used in a claim herein, the phrase “consisting essentially of” limits the scope of a claim to the specified materials or steps and those that do not materially affect the basic and novel characteristic(s) of the claimed invention.
  • Unless otherwise defined, all technical and scientific terms used herein have the same meaning as commonly understood by one of ordinary skill in the art to which this invention belongs. Although methods and materials similar or equivalent to those described herein can be used in the practice or testing of the present invention, suitable methods and materials are described below. All publications, patent applications, patents, and other references mentioned herein are incorporated by reference in their entirety. In case of conflict, the present specification, including definitions, will control. In addition, the materials, methods, and examples are illustrative only and not intended to be limiting.
  • Other features and advantages of the invention will be apparent from the following detailed description, and from the claims.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIG. 1 is a 1H NMR spectra of compound 11 (which is described below in Example 1 and has the chemical structure of Structure 1005b herein).
  • FIG. 1A is a 1H NMR spectra of Structure 1004b herein (which is described below in Example 1).
  • FIG. 2 is a 31P NMR spectra of compound 19 (which is described below in Example 2 and has the chemical structure of Structure 1008b herein.).
  • FIG. 2A is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 19.
  • FIG. 2B is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 14 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2C is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 15 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2D is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 16 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2E is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 17 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 2F is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 18 (which is described below in Example 2).
  • FIG. 3 is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 30 (which is described below in Example 3).
  • FIG. 4 is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 38 (which is described below in Example 4).
  • FIG. 5 is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 44 (which is described below in Example 5).
  • FIG. 6 is a 1H NMR spectra of Compound 47 (which is described below in Example 6).
  • FIG. 7 is a photograph of a PEG linker-GalNAc phosphoramidite-containing compound in a bottle (which is described below in Example 7).
  • FIG. 8 is a photograph of Structure 1008b phosphoramidite-containing compound in a bottle (which is described below in Example 7).
  • FIG. 9 is a 31P NMR spectra of a PEG linker-GalNAc Structure (which is described below in Example 8).
  • FIG. 10 is a graph illustrating normalized mouse Factor 12 (mF12) protein levels in wild type mice (which is described below in Example 11).
  • FIG. 11 is a graph illustrating normalized mouse Factor 12 (F12) protein levels in wild type mice (which is described below in Example 12).
  • FIG. 12 is a graph illustrating normalized lipoprotein(a) (Lp(a)) particle levels in Lp(a) transgenic (Tg) mice (which is described below in Example 13).
  • FIG. 13 is a graph illustrating normalized apo(a) levels in apo(a) transgenic (Tg) mice (which is described below in Example 14).
  • FIG. 14 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in Lp(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 15) FIG. 15 is a graph illustrating normalized mouse F12 protein levels in wild type mice (which is described below in Example 16).
  • FIG. 16 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in Lp(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 17).
  • FIG. 17 is a graph illustrating normalized apo(a) levels in apo(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 18).
  • FIG. 18 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in Lp(a) Tg mice (which is described below in Example 19).
  • FIG. 19 is a graph illustrating normalized Lp(a) particle levels in cynomolgus monkeys (which is described below in Example 20).
  • FIG. 20 is a graph illustrating normalized cF12 protein levels in cynomolgus monkeys (which is described below in Example 21).
  • FIG. 21 is a graph illustrating normalized AAT (Z-AAT) protein levels in PiZ transgenic mice (which is described below in Example 22).
  • FIG. 22 is a structure showing Formula I.
  • FIG. 23 is a structure showing Formula I.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • Described herein are targeting ligands that are linked to compounds, such as therapeutic or diagnostic compounds. In some embodiments, the compounds that are linked to the targeting ligands described herein include or consist of therapeutic compounds such as expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds. The targeting ligands can be used to target therapeutic compounds to a desired location of a target nucleic acid or target gene. Also described herein are compositions including targeting ligands and therapeutic compounds, such as compositions including or consisting of targeting ligands and expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds.
  • The new targeting ligands described herein provide advantages over previously known targeting ligands to facilitate the delivery of therapeutic compounds. These advantages include, for example, improvements to the ease and efficiency of manufacture, while also providing efficient targeting or bio-distribution, sufficient stability in vivo and/or in vitro, and/or other improvements desirable for oligonucleotide therapeutic product delivery. The new targeting ligands are also particularly suitable for synthesis as phosphoramidite compounds, which reduces the cost and burden of manufacture, and facilitates the convenient attachment of the targeting ligand to compounds, especially expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (such as RNAi agents), while providing similar, or in some cases improved, delivery and/or efficacy of the therapeutic compound.
  • Targeting Ligands
  • Targeting ligands are comprised of one or more targeting group(s) or targeting moiety(ies), which can serve to enhance the pharmacokinetic or bio-distribution properties of the compound to which they are linked, and improve cell- or tissue-specific distribution and cell-specific uptake of the conjugated composition. In general, a targeting ligand aids in directing the delivery of the therapeutic compound to which it is linked to the desired target site. In some instances, the targeting moiety may bind to a cell or cell receptor, and initiate endocytosis to facilitate entry of the therapeutic compound into the cell. Targeting moieties can include compounds with affinity to cell receptors or cell surface molecules or antibodies. A variety of targeting ligands that contain targeting moieties can be linked to therapeutic agents and other compounds to target the agents to cells and specific cellular receptors. Types of targeting moieties include carbohydrates, cholesterol and cholesteryl groups, and steroids. Targeting moieties that can bind to cell receptors include saccharides, such as galactose, galactose derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine), mannose, and mannose derivatives; other carbohydrates; glycans; haptens; vitamins; folate; biotin; aptamers; and peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and transferrin.
  • Targeting moieties that are known to bind to the asialoglycoprotein receptor (ASGPR) are particularly useful in directing the delivery of oligomeric compounds to the liver. Asialoglycoprotein receptors are abundantly expressed on liver cells, including hepatocytes. Cell receptor targeting moieties that target ASGPR include galactose and galactose derivatives. In particular, clusters of galactose derivatives, including clusters comprised of two, three, or four N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG), can facilitate uptake of certain compounds in liver cells. GalNAc clusters conjugated to oligomeric compounds serve to direct the composition to the liver, where the N-acetyl-galactosamine sugars are able to bind to the asialoglycoprotein receptors on the surface of the liver cell. The binding to an asialoglycoprotein receptor is believed to initiate receptor-mediated endocytosis, thereby facilitating entry of the compound into the interior of the cell.
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein may include one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties linked to a branch point group. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties linked to a branch point group wherein each targeting moiety is linked to the branch point group via a tether.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four asialoglycoprotein receptor (ASGPR) targeting moieties linked to a branch point group. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one, two, three, four, or more than four ASGPR targeting moieties linked to a branch point group wherein each ASGPR targeting moiety is linked to the branch point group via a tether.
  • In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to a linker. In some embodiments, the branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety, and the branch point group is linked to a therapeutic compound. In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to an oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is represented by the following Formula I, as shown in FIG. 22, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3 or 4) (Formula I). In some embodiments, n in Formula I is an integer from 1-3, 1-2, 2-4, 2-3, or 3-4.
  • The linker of Formula I is a group that includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted moieties selected from cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl group(s), or covalently linked combination(s) thereof, that connects a branch point group on one end of the linker to a therapeutic compound (or to the phosphorous atom of a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is synthesized as a phosphoramidite compound) on the other end of the linker. In some embodiments, one or more additional groups, such as cleavable moieties (such as phosphate group or a group containing a disulfide bond) or groups forming phosphorothioate or phosphonate linkage(s), are inserted between the therapeutic compound and the linker. The linkers are “rigid” in that they impart sufficient stability and rigidity to the overall targeting ligand to reduce interaction between the targeting moiety(ies) of Formula I and the therapeutic compound to which it is linked. This, in turn, can improve the interaction of the targeting moiety with the target site. Additionally, the linkers for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein are specifically designed for synthesizing the targeting ligand(s) as phosphoramidite compounds, which enables the efficient linkage of the targeting ligand to the 5′ terminal end of an oligomeric compound.
  • The branch point group of Formula I is any group that enables attachment of one or more targeting moieties (via one or more tethers) to the linker.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is represented by the following Formula II, as shown in FIG. 23, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3 or 4). In some embodiments, n in Formula II is an integer from 1-3, 1-2, 2-4, 2-3, or 3-4.
  • In Formula II, the branch point group is any group that enables attachment of one or more targeting moieties (via one or more tethers) to a therapeutic compound (or to the phosphorous atom of a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is synthesized as a phosphoramidite compound) via a linker replacement moiety. As used herein, a branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety when the branch point group includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl group(s), or combination(s) thereof (including fused, within the branch point group, which serves the same function as the rigid linkers of Formula I as disclosed herein.
  • The one or more tethers of Formula I and II are groups that serve as a spacer that may further add flexibility and/or length to the linkage between the targeting moiety and the branch point group. The tether provides an efficient way to link a targeting moiety to the branch point group. For the targeting ligands disclosed herein, there is at least one tether for each targeting moiety. In some embodiments, there are multiple (i.e., two or more) tethers between the branch point group and the targeting moiety.
  • The targeting moieties of Formulas I and II are groups that serve to enhance the pharmacokinetic or bio-distribution properties of the therapeutic compound to which they are linked, and improve cell- or tissue-specific distribution and cell-specific uptake of the conjugated composition. Targeting moieties can include compounds with affinity to cell receptors or cell surface molecules or antibodies. Types of targeting moieties include carbohydrates, cholesterol and cholesteryl groups, and steroids. Targeting moieties that can bind to cell receptors include saccharides, such as galactose, galactose derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine), mannose, and mannose derivatives; other carbohydrates; glycans; haptens; vitamins; folate; biotin; aptamers; and peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and transferrin.
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein can be linked to therapeutic compounds. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to the therapeutic compound via an additional linker and/or a cleavable moiety, which is then linked to the therapeutic compound. In some embodiments, targeting ligands are ligated to the therapeutic compound itself.
  • In some embodiments, the therapeutic compound is an oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the therapeutic compound is an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, a targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 3′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 5′ end or the 3′ end of the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly or indirectly to the 5′ end or the 3′ end of a single-stranded RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, a targeting ligand is linked to a double-stranded RNAi agent via a phosphate, phosphonate, phosphorothioate, or other internucleoside linking group, at the 5′ end of the terminal nucleoside of the sense strand of the double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, a targeting ligand disclosed herein includes a cleavable moiety. In some embodiments, a cleavable moiety includes or consists of a phosphate or other internucleoside linking group that may be cleaved. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to a therapeutic compound via a cleavable moiety.
  • In some embodiments, a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked to an additional group or groups that includes a cleavable moiety. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to a cleavable moiety, which is then linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound. A phosphoramidite compound including a targeting ligand described herein may be useful to readily attach the targeting ligand to the therapeutic compound or to other groups, using methods generally known in the art for phosphoramidite synthesis. In some embodiments, the phosphoramidite compound including the targeting ligand is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound using methods generally known in the art. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand-containing phosphoramidite is linked to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand includes a single-stranded oligonucleotide. In some embodiments, the single-stranded oligonucleotide is a single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked directly to a single-stranded antisense oligonucleotide. In some embodiments, additional groups are inserted between a targeting ligand and a single-stranded oligonucleotide.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand linked to an RNAi agent includes one or more N-acetyl-galactosamine sugars as a targeting moiety or targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound includes a tether that includes polyethylene glycol (PEG). In some embodiments, a tether consists of PEG. In some embodiments a tether includes a PEG having 1 to 10 ethylene glycol units. In some embodiments a tether includes a PEG having 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 ethylene glycol units.
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to any of the targeting ligands disclosed herein includes an RNAi agent. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked, either directly or indirectly, to an RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked directly to an RNAi agent. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand disclosed herein is linked indirectly to an RNAi agent, as additional group(s) are inserted between the RNAi agent and the linker of the targeting ligand. In some embodiments, a second linker is included between the linker and the therapeutic compound.
  • Linkers
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise a linker, as shown in Formula I, or alternatively the branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety, as shown in Formula I.
  • The linker is a group of atoms linked to a branch point group on one end, and linked to a therapeutic compound (or to the phosphorous atom of a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is synthesized as a phosphoramidite compound) on the other end. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to a branch point group on one end, and is ligated on the other end to a group or groups that are then ligated to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the linker is directly linked to an oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to a cleavable moiety, which is then linked to an oligomeric compound. Examples of cleavable moieties include, for example, phosphate groups, groups including a disulfide moiety, and/or other internucleoside linkages that may be cleaved. In some embodiments, the linker is not linked to a cleavable moiety. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to a phosphorothioate or phosphonate group.
  • For the targeting ligands disclosed herein according to Formula I, the linker is a “rigid” linker. A rigid linker is a linking group that includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl group(s), or covalently linked combination(s) thereof.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00031
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00032
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00033
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00034
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00035
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00036
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00037
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00038
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00039
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00040
  • wherein n′ is an integer from 0 to 10 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10), and for each Z′ present, Z′ is independently selected, and Z′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure 7).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00041
  • wherein n″ is an integer from 0 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3 or 4), and for each Z″ present, Z″ is independently selected, and Z″ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure 8).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand of Formula I includes or consists of a linker having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00042
  • wherein V includes or consists of one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), or heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.), or any covalently linked combination thereof. (Structure 9).
  • In some embodiments, the linkers suitable for use in the targeting ligands disclosed herein are generated from a compound that includes a rigid structure with a terminal carboxylic acid moiety (or activated ester thereof) on one end, and a terminal alcohol moiety on the other end. In some embodiments, the alcohol moiety is a secondary alcohol. In some embodiments, the alcohol moiety is a tertiary alcohol. In some embodiments, the alcohol moiety is a primary alcohol. The carboxylic acid moiety (or activated ester thereof) is suitable for attachment to the branch point group, while the alcohol moiety is suitable for attachment to the phosphorus atom of a phosphoramidite through a phosphitylation reaction with a phosphoramidite forming reagent. Example phosphitylation reactions using phosphoramidite forming reagents are described in the Examples herein. The linker structures disclosed herein are suitable for preparation of the targeting ligand as a phosphoramidite compound.
  • In some embodiments, the linker is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound that is a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to the 3′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments the linker is linked to the 3′ end of the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the linker is linked to the 5′ end of the antisense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, the linker is linked to a cleavable moiety. In some embodiments, a terminal phosphate group of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can serve as a cleavable moiety. In some embodiments, an independently selected cleavable moiety is linked to a linker. As used herein, a cleavable moiety is a group that is stable outside of the cell, but upon entry into the target cell is cleaved. Cleavable moieties are susceptible to cleavage under certain conditions, such as pH, or certain cleavage agents, such as molecules that promote degradation or redox agents.
  • In some embodiments, the cleavable moiety may be susceptible to pH. For example, endosomes and lysosomes are known to generally have a more acidic pH (pH of approximately 4.5 to 6.5) than human blood (pH of approximately 7.35 to 7.45), and as such may promote the cleavage of a cleavable moiety.
  • In some embodiments, a cleavable moiety is a phosphate group. Phosphate groups may be cleaved by agents that are known to degrade or hydrolyze phosphate groups.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise a branch point group that includes a linker replacement group, instead of a linker, as shown in Formula II. When the linker is replaced with a linker replacement moiety, the linker replacement moiety is a part of the branch point group.
  • In some embodiments, the linkers and linker replacement moieties disclosed herein permits the incorporation of only a single isomer of a targeting ligand, which can provide additional advantages for oligonucleotide therapeutic products.
  • Branch Point Groups
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise at least one branch point group. In some embodiments, the branch point group of the targeting ligands disclosed herein is linked to a linker. In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to a linker on one end, and the branch point group is linked to one or more tethers on the other end(s). In some embodiments, the branch point group is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound via an additional group or groups. In some embodiments, the branch point group includes a linker replacement moiety and is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • The branch point groups disclosed herein can be of any group which permits attachment of one or more targeting moieties and further permits attachment to a linker disclosed herein, or, alternatively, if the branch point group comprises a linker replacement moiety, the branch point group can be any group that includes a linker replacement moiety that permits attachment to a therapeutic compound, such as an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • For the branch point groups of Formula I, disclosed herein, prior to conjugation to a linker, the branch point group compound that serves to generate the branch point group has one terminal amine for each desired linkage to a linker, and one terminal carboxylic acid moiety (or activated ester thereof) for each desired linkage to a tether.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point having a structure selected from the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00043
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00044
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00045
  • wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (Structure 209).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00046
  • wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20) (Structure 210).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00047
  • wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); x is an integer from to 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10); y is an integer from 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); z is an integer from 1 to 4 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, or 4); and K is selected from the group consisting of substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), and substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.), or covalently linked combinations thereof (Structure 211).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00048
  • wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); x is an integer from to 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10); and y is an integer from 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10) (Structure 212).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00049
  • wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20); x is an integer from to 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10); y is an integer from 1 to 10 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10); and G is selected from the group consisting of
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00050
  • or any substituted or unsubstituted cyclic or heterocyclic structure having a ring size of 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 atoms, for example, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), or substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.) (Structure 213).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00051
  • wherein n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20) (Structure 214).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00052
  • wherein n is an integer from 0 to 20 (e.g., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and Q is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00053
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00054
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00055
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00056
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00057
  • wherein n is an integer selected from 1 to 7 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7) (Structure 219). In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 1. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 2. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 3. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 4. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 5. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 6. In some embodiments, n in Structure 219 is 7.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group that includes a linker replacement group.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a branch point group that includes a linker replacement moiety having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00058
  • Tethers
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein comprise one or more tethers. A tether is linked between the branch point group and each targeting moiety. In some embodiments, the tether is linked directly to the targeting ligand on one end and directly to the branch point group on the other end. In some embodiments, the tether is linked directly to the targeting ligand on one end, and indirectly to the branch point group on the other end. In some embodiments, the tether is linked indirectly to the targeting ligand on one end and indirectly to the branch point group on the other end. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand described herein includes three tethers and three targeting moieties. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand described herein includes four tethers and four targeting moieties. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand described herein includes one tether and one targeting moiety. In some embodiments, a targeting ligand described herein includes multiple tethers and multiple targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, additional tethers or other groups are inserted between the tether and the targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I. In some embodiments, a second tether is inserted between a tether and a targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I. In some embodiments, a second tether and a third tether is inserted between a tether and a targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I. In some embodiments, a second, third, and fourth tether is inserted between a tether and a targeting moiety of Formula I or Formula I. As disclosed herein, there is at least one tether present for every targeting moiety. In some embodiments, there is more than one tether present for each targeting moiety. The targeting ligands disclosed herein are intended to cover such compositions.
  • In some embodiments, additional groups can be inserted between the tether and the branch point group of Formula I or Formula I.
  • As disclosed herein, the tether serves as a spacer that may further add flexibility and/or length to the linkage between the targeting moiety and the branch point group, linker, and therapeutic compound. In some embodiments, the tether includes alkyl groups (including cycloalkyl groups), alkenyl groups (including cycloalkenyl groups), alkynyl groups, aryl groups, aralkyl groups, aralkenyl groups, or aralkynyl groups. In some embodiments, the tether includes one or more heteroatoms, heterocycles, heteroaryls, amino acids, nucleotides, or saccharides.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00059
  • wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH (Structure 301).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00060
  • wherein X is O, S, or NH (Structure 302).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00061
  • In some embodiments the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00062
  • wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH. (Structure 303).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00063
  • wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH. (Structure 304).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00064
  • wherein X is O, S, or NH (Structure 305).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes a tether having the following structure:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00065
  • wherein X is O, S, or NH (Structure 306).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes more than one type of tether. In some embodiments, the tether acts as a flexible hydrophilic spacer (See, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,885,968; and Biessen et al. J. Med. Chem. 1995, 39, 1538-1546, both of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety), and includes a PEG spacer. In other embodiments, the PEG spacer has 1 to 20 ethylene units (PEG1 to PEG20). For example, the PEG spacer has 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 ethylene units.
  • Targeting Moieties
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein can include one to four, or more than four, targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands may be a galactose cluster. As used herein, a galactose cluster includes a targeting ligand having two to four terminal galactose derivatives. As used herein, the term galactose derivative includes both galactose and derivatives of galactose having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor equal to or greater than that of galactose. A galactose derivative is a saccharide sugar that is a type of targeting moiety. A terminal galactose derivative is linked to a tether through the C-1 carbon of the saccharide.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is comprised of three terminal galactosamines or galactosamine derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine) each having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG) as the targeting moieties. For example, each of Structures 1001, 1002, 1004 and 1008 are targeting ligands having three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines as the targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, each targeting moiety includes a galactosamine derivative that is N-acetyl-galactosamine. Other saccharides having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor that may be used as targeting moieties may be selected from the list including: galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, and N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine. The affinities of numerous galactose derivatives for the asialoglycoprotein receptor have been studied (see, for example, Iobst, S. T. and Drickamer, K J.B.C. 1996, 271, 6686, which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety) or are readily determined using methods well known and commonly used in the art.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting moiety is a cell-targeting moiety.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting moiety includes an N-acetyl-galactosamine:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00066
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes three targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes four targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes one targeting moiety. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes two targeting moieties. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes four or more targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting moiety includes one or more of galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, or N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
  • For example, in some embodiments, the N-acetyl-galactosamine targeting moieties in any of Structures 1001 through 1027 can be replaced with alternative targeting moieties. Such alternative targeting moieties include, for example, galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, or N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
  • Additionally, in some embodiments, the targeting moieties of Structures 1001 through 1027 may be replaced with, for example, other carbohydrates; glycans; haptens; vitamins; folate; biotin; aptamers; and/or peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and/or transferrin.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is in the form of an N-acetyl-galactosamine trimer. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is in the form of an N-acetyl-galactosamine tetramer.
  • Representative Targeting Ligand Structures, and Phosphoramidite Compounds Including Targeting Ligands
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein may be comprised of one or more targeting moieties, tethers, branch point groups, and linkers. The targeting ligands disclosed herein may be comprised of one, two, three, four, or more than four targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein are synthesized to be in the form of a phosphoramidite compound. Phosphoramidites are widely used in the chemical synthesis of RNA and DNA. In some embodiments, the phosphoramidite-containing targeting ligands disclosed herein are added to the 5′ end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. It can be especially advantageous to prepare the targeting ligand as a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is to be linked to the 5′ terminal end of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. Not wishing to be bound by theory, it is understood that preparing the targeting ligand as a phosphoramidite when the targeting ligand is linked to the 5′ terminal end of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound allows for the linkage of the targeting ligand as the last component (thus reducing manufacturing costs), as well as potentially permits the targeting ligand to block the loading of the sense strand into RISC when the targeting ligand is attached to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of a double-stranded RNAi agent. When an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent, the targeting ligand can be prepared as a phosphoramidite compound when the targeting ligand is to be linked to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of the RNAi agent.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00067
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00068
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1001a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00069
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1001a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00070
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00071
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00072
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1002a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00073
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1002a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00074
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00075
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00076
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1003a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00077
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1003a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure re resented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00078
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00079
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00080
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1004a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00081
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1004a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00082
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00083
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00084
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1005a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00085
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1005a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00086
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00087
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00088
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1006a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00089
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1006a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented b the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00090
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00091
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00092
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1007a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00093
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1007a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00094
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00095
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00096
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1008a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00097
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1008a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00098
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00099
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00100
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1009a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00101
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1009a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00102
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00103
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00104
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1010a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00105
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1010a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00106
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and includes the structure represented by the following;
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00107
  • wherein J includes or consists of one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl groups, or covalently linked combinations thereof; Y is O or S; R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; and Y′ is O, S, or NH (Structure 1011).
  • In some embodiments the targeting ligand has the structure represented b the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00108
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00109
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1012a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00110
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1012a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00111
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00112
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00113
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1013a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00114
  • Wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1013a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00115
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00116
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00117
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1014a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00118
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1014a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00119
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00120
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00121
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1015a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00122
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1015a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00123
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00124
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00125
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1016a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00126
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1016a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00127
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00128
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00129
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1017a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00130
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1017a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00131
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00132
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00133
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1018a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00134
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1018a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00135
  • In some embodiments, the targeting has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00136
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00137
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1019a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00138
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1019a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00139
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00140
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00141
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1020a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00142
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1020a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00143
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00144
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00145
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1021a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00146
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1021a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00147
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00148
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00149
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1022a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00150
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1022a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00151
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00152
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00153
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1023a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00154
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1023a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00155
  • In some embodiments, as disclosed herein, the linker of the targeting ligand may be absent, so long as the branch point group includes at least one aryl, cycloalkyl, and/or heterocyclic group. Having one or more aryl, cycloalkyl, and/or heterocyclic groups located within the branch point group serves as a linker replacement group. In some embodiments, the one or more aryl, cycloalkyl, and/or heterocyclic groups within the branch point group are positioned between the central connection point(s) of the branch point group and the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00156
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00157
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1024a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00158
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1024a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00159
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00160
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00161
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1025a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00162
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1025a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00163
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00164
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00165
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1026a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00166
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1026a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00167
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00168
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00169
  • wherein R includes or consists of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. (Structure 1027a).
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is linked to the targeting ligand and has the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00170
  • wherein R consists of or includes an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound; Y is O or S; and Y′ is O, S, or NH. (Structure 1027a(i)).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is a phosphoramidite-containing compound having the structure represented by the following:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00171
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is in the form of a galactose cluster. As used herein, a galactose cluster includes a targeting ligand having two to four terminal galactose derivatives. As used herein, the term galactose derivative includes both galactose and derivatives of galactose having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor equal to or greater than that of galactose. A galactose derivative is a saccharide sugar that is a type of targeting moiety. A terminal galactose derivative may be linked to a tether through the C-1 carbon of the saccharide.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is comprised of three terminal galactosamines or galactosamine derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine) each having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG) as the targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is comprised of four terminal galactosamines or galactosamine derivatives (such as N-acetyl-galactosamine) each having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand includes four terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines (GalNAc or NAG) as the targeting moieties.
  • In some embodiments, each targeting moiety includes a galactosamine derivative that is N-acetyl-galactosamine. Other saccharides having affinity for the asialoglycoprotein receptor that may be used as targeting moieties may be selected from the list including: galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, and N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine. The affinities of numerous galactose derivatives for the asialoglycoprotein receptor have been studied (see for example: Iobst, S. T. and Drickamer, K J.B.C. 1996, 271, 6686) or are readily determined using methods well known and commonly used in the art.
  • Terms commonly used in the art when referring to three terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines include tri-antennary, tri-valent, and trimer.
  • Terms commonly used in the art when referring to four terminal N-acetyl-galactosamines include tetra-antennary, tetra-valent, and tetramer.
  • Oligomeric Compounds
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein can be linked to an oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the oligomeric compound is an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent. In some embodiments the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a single-stranded oligonucleotide. The expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds may be synthesized using methods commonly used in the art.
  • The expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds may include one or more modified nucleotides. A nucleotide base (or nucleobase) is a heterocyclic pyrimidine or purine compound which is a constituent of all nucleic acids and includes adenine (A), guanine (G), cytosine (C), thymine (T), and uracil (U). As used herein, the term “nucleotide” may include a modified nucleotide or nucleotide mimic, abasic site, or a surrogate replacement moiety. As used herein, a “modified nucleotide” is a nucleotide, nucleotide mimic, abasic site, or a surrogate replacement moiety other than a ribonucleotide (2′-hydroxyl nucleotide). In some embodiments a modified nucleotide includes a 2′-modified nucleotide (i.e. a nucleotide with a group other than a hydroxyl group at the 2′ position of the five-membered sugar ring). Modified nucleotides include, but are not limited to: 2′-modified nucleotides, 2′-O-methyl nucleotides (represented herein as a lower case letter ‘n’ in a nucleotide sequence), 2′-deoxy-2′-fluoro nucleotides (represented herein as Nf, also represented herein as 2′-fluoro nucleotide), 2′-deoxy nucleotides (represented herein as dN), 2′-methoxyethyl (2′-O-2-methoxylethyl) nucleotides, (represented herein as NM or 2′-MOE), 2′-amino nucleotides, 2′-alkyl nucleotides, 3′ to 3′ linkages (inverted) nucleotides (represented herein as invdN, invN, invn, invX), non-natural base including nucleotides, locked nucleotides, bridged nucleotides, peptide nucleic acids, 2′,3′-seco nucleotide mimics (unlocked nucleobase analogues, represented herein as NUNAorNUNA), locked nucleotide (represented herein as NLNA or NLNA), 3′-O-methoxy (2′ internucleotide linked) nucleotide (represented herein as 3′-OMen), 2′-F-arabino nucleotides (represented herein as NfANA or NfANA), morpholino nucleotides, vinyl phosphonate deoxyribonucleotide (represented herein as vpdN), vinyl phosphonate nucleotides, and abasic nucleotides (represented herein as X or Ab). It is not necessary for all positions in a given compound to be uniformly modified. Conversely, more than one modification may be incorporated in a single expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound or even in a single nucleotide thereof. The expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds may be synthesized and/or modified by methods known in the art. Modification at each nucleotide is independent of modification of the other nucleotides.
  • Modified nucleobases include synthetic and natural nucleobases, such as 5-substituted pyrimidines, 6-azapyrimidines, N-2-, N-6-, and O-6-substituted purines (e.g., 2-aminopropyladenine), 5-propynyluracil, 5-propynylcytosine, 5-methylcytosine (5-me-C), 5-hydroxymethyl cytosine, xanthine, hypoxanthine, 2-aminoadenine, 6-methyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-propyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-thiouracil, 2-thiothymine, 2-thiocytosine, 5-halouracil, 5-halocytosine, 5-propynyl uracil, 5-propynyl cytosine, 6-azo-uracil, 6-azo-cytosine, 6-azo-thymine, 5-uracil (pseudouracil), 4-thiouracil, 8-halo, 8-amino, 8-thiol, 8-thioalkyl, 8-hydroxyl and other 8-substituted adenines and guanines, 5-substituted uracils and cytosines (e.g., 5-halo uracils and cytosines (e.g., 5-bromouracil and 5-bromocytosine), 5-trifluoromethyl uracil, 5-trifluoromethyl cytosine), 7-methylguanine, 7-methyladenine, 8-azaguanine, 8-azaadenine, 7-deazaguanine, 7-deazaadenine, 3-deazaguanine, and 3-deazaadenine.
  • For the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds described herein, any modified nucleotides may be linked by phosphate-containing or non-phosphate-containing covalent internucleoside linkages. Modified internucleoside linkages or backbones include, but are not limited to, 5′-phosphorothioate group (represented herein as a lower case ‘s’ before a nucleotide, as in sN, sn, sNf, or sdN), chiral phosphorothioates, thiophosphate, phosphorodithioates, phosphotriesters, aminoalkyl-phosphotriesters, methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3′-alkylene phosphonates and chiral phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3′-amino phosphoramidate and aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkyl-phosphonates, thionoalkylphosphotriesters, morpholino linkages, boranophosphates having normal 3′-5′ linkages, 2′-5′ linked analogs of boranophosphates, and boranophosphates having inverted polarity wherein the adjacent pairs of nucleoside units are linked 3′-5′ to 5′-3′ or 2′-5′ to 5′-2′. In some embodiments, a modified internucleoside linkage or backbone lacks a phosphorus atom. Modified internucleoside linkages lacking a phosphorus atom include, but are not limited to, short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl inter-sugar linkages, mixed heteroatom and alkyl or cycloalkyl inter-sugar linkages, or one or more short chain heteroatomic or heterocyclic inter-sugar linkages. In some embodiments, modified internucleoside backbones include, but are not limited to, siloxane backbones, sulfide backbones, sulfoxide backbones, sulfone backbones, formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones, methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones, alkene-containing backbones, sulfamate backbones, methyleneimino and methylenehydrazino backbones, sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones, amide backbones, and other backbones having mixed N, O, S, and CH2 components.
  • In some embodiments, an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a double-stranded RNAi agent, and includes a sense strand and an antisense strand that are at least partially complementary (at least 70% complementary) to each other. The antisense strand contains a region having a sequence that is perfectly complementary (100% complementary) or at least substantially complementary (at least 85% complementary) to a sequence in a target mRNA. The length of a double-stranded RNAi agent sense strand and antisense strand each can be 16 to 30 nucleotides in length. The sense and antisense strands can be either the same length or they can be different lengths. In some embodiments, the sense strand is about 19 nucleotides in length while the antisense strand is about 21 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, the sense strand is about 21 nucleotides in length while the antisense strand is about 23 nucleotides in length. In other embodiments, the sense and antisense strands are each independently 17-21 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, both the sense and antisense strands are each 21-26 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, both the sense and antisense strands are each 26 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, the sense and antisense strands are each independently 17 to 26 nucleotides in length. In some embodiments, a double-stranded RNAi agent has a duplex length of about 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23 or 24 nucleotides. This region of perfect or substantial complementarity between the sense strand and the antisense strand is typically 15-25 (e.g., 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, or 25 nucleotides in length) nucleotides in length and occurs at or near the 5′ end of the antisense strand.
  • The expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds that are conjugated to the ligands disclosed herein optionally and independently include an additional 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 nucleotides (as an extension) at the 3′ end, the 5′ end, or both the 3′ and 5′ ends of the core sequences. These additional nucleotides, if present, may or may not be complementary to the corresponding sequence in the targeted mRNA.
  • In some embodiments, when a double-stranded RNAi agent is conjugated to the targeting ligands disclosed herein, the additional sense strand additional nucleotides, if present, may or may not be identical to the corresponding sequence in the targeted mRNA. The additional antisense strand additional nucleotides, if present, may or may not be complementary to the corresponding additional nucleotides of the sense strand, if present.
  • Double-stranded RNAi agents can be formed by annealing an antisense strand with a sense strand.
  • In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to an RNAi agent at the 3′ or 5′ end of either the sense strand or the antisense strand of the RNAi agent. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to 5′ end of the sense strand. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to the 3′ end of the sense strand. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is linked to the RNAi agent via a labile, cleavable, or reversible bond. In some embodiments, the labile, cleavable, or reversible bond is included in a cleavable moiety added between the RNAi agent and the targeting ligand.
  • In some embodiments, the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is a single-stranded oligonucleotide. In some embodiments, the single-stranded oligonucleotide is utilizes the RNA interference mechanism to inhibit expression of the target mRNA. In some embodiments, the single-stranded oligonucleotides are active in reducing expression of the target nucleic acid through a mechanism other than RNA interference.
  • In some embodiments, the gene expression level and/or mRNA level of a target in a subject to whom a described targeting ligand conjugated to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, by at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject prior to administration or to a subject not receiving the targeting ligand conjugate. The gene expression level and/or mRNA level in the subject may be reduced in a cell, group of cells, and/or tissue of the subject. In some embodiments, the protein level in a subject to whom a described targeting ligand conjugated to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound has been administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, by at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject prior to being administered the targeting ligand conjugate or to a subject not receiving the targeting ligand conjugate. The protein level in the subject may be reduced in a cell, group of cells, tissue, blood, and/or other fluid of the subject. A reduction in gene expression, mRNA, or protein levels can be assessed by any methods known in the art. Reduction or decrease in mRNA level and/or protein level are collectively referred to herein as inhibiting, decreasing, or reducing the expression of the targeted gene.
  • Specific expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds that can be used with the targeting ligands disclosed are known in the art. In particular, numerous references disclose expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds that may be conjugated to the targeting ligands disclosed herein for delivery of the composition to the liver. Non-limiting examples include U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/281,309, entitled Compositions and Methods for Inhibiting Gene Expression of LPA, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting the human apolipoprotein(a) gene [LPA](to inhibit expression of the apo(a) protein which is part of the lipoprotein(a) particle, and thereby the lipoprotein(a) particle (Lp(a))), that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein. The apo(a) gene [LPA] is expressed predominantly in the liver in humans and non-human primates. Similarly, for example, U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/229,314, entitled RNAi Therapy for Hepatitis B Virus Infection, which is also incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting the hepatitis B virus, that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein. The Hepatitis B Virus is a strict hepatotrophic, double-stranded DNA containing virus and is classified as one member of the Hepadnaviruses, belonging to the family of Hepadnaviridae. Further, as another example, U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/229,314, entitled Compositions and Methods for Inhibiting Gene Expression of Factor XII, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting the Factor XII (or Factor 12, F12) gene, that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein. Factor XII is a serine protease expressed predominantly in the liver and found in blood. Additionally, as another example U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/740,307, entitled Compositions and Methods for Inhibiting Gene Expression of Alpha-1 AntiTrypsin, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting the alpha-1 antitrypsin (or AAT) gene, that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein. AAT is a protease inhibitor belonging to the serpin superfamily, and normal AAT protein is primarily synthesized in the liver by hepatocytes and secreted into blood. Further, WO 2016/01123, entitled Organic Compositions to Treat APOC3-Related Diseases, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, discloses various double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds targeting human apolipoprotein III (APOC3), that are suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein. Apolipoprotein C-III is a constituent of lipoproteins that is believed to inhibit hepatic uptake of triglyceride-rich particles. Additional references disclosing various therapeutic compounds, including expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, that may be suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein, can also be found in the art. These include, but are not limited to, compositions where targeting to the liver would be desirable.
  • Pharmaceutical Compositions and Formulations
  • The targeting ligands disclosed herein, when linked to an oligomeric compound, can be used to treat a subject (e.g., a human or mammal) having a disease or disorder that would benefit from administration of the compound. In some embodiments, the targeting ligands disclosed herein, when linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, can be used to treat a subject (e.g., a human) having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction or inhibition in expression of the target mRNA. The subject is administered a therapeutically effective amount of any one or more expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, such as an RNAi agent, that is linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein. The subject can be a human, patient, or human patient. The subject may be an adult, adolescent, child, or infant. The described pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound can be used to provide methods for the therapeutic treatment of diseases. Such methods include administration of a pharmaceutical composition described herein to a human being or animal.
  • The pharmaceutical compositions and methods disclosed herein may decrease the level of the target mRNA in a cell, group of cells, group of cells, tissue, or subject, including: administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a herein described expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound that is linked to a targeting ligand, thereby inhibiting the expression of a target mRNA in the subject. In some embodiments, the subject has been previously identified as having a pathogenic upregulation of the target gene in the targeted cell or tissue.
  • In some embodiments, pharmaceutical compositions include at least one expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand. These pharmaceutical compositions are particularly useful in the inhibition of the expression of the target mRNA in a target cell, a group of cells, a tissue, or an organism. The pharmaceutical compositions can be used to treat a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in the level of the target mRNA, or inhibition in expression of the target gene. The pharmaceutical compositions can be used to treat a subject at risk of developing a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction of the level of the target mRNA or an inhibition in expression the target gene. In one embodiment, the method includes administering a composition including a targeting ligand as described herein linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, such as an RNAi agent, to a subject to be treated. In some embodiments, one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients (including vehicles, carriers, diluents, and/or delivery polymers) are added to the pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, thereby forming a pharmaceutical formulation suitable for in vivo delivery to a human.
  • In some embodiments, the described pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound are used for treating or managing clinical presentations associated with expression of a target mRNA. In some embodiments, a therapeutically or prophylactically effective amount of one or more of pharmaceutical compositions is administered to a subject in need of such treatment, prevention or management. In some embodiments, administration of any of the conjugated ligands covalently linked to an oligomeric compound can be used to decrease the number, severity, and/or frequency of symptoms of a disease in a subject.
  • The described pharmaceutical compositions including a targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, can be used to treat at least one symptom in a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction or inhibition in expression of a target mRNA. In some embodiments, the subject is administered a therapeutically effective amount of one or more pharmaceutical compositions including an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, such as an RNAi agent, linked to a targeting ligand described herein, thereby treating the symptom. In other embodiments, the subject is administered a prophylactically effective amount of one or more of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds thereby preventing the at least one symptom.
  • In some embodiments, the expression or level of a target mRNA in a subject to whom an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein is administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, but at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject not receiving the pharmaceutical composition. The gene expression level in the subject may be reduced in a cell, group of cells, and/or tissue of the subject. In some embodiments, the level of mRNA is reduced. In other embodiments, the expressed protein level is reduced. In some embodiments, the level of protein in a subject to whom an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand disclosed herein is administered is reduced by at least about 5%, for example, but at least about 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or 98% relative to the subject not receiving the pharmaceutical composition. Reduction in expression, mRNA levels, or protein levels can be assessed by any methods known in the art. Reduction or decrease in mRNA level and/or protein level are collectively referred to herein as a reduction or decrease in target RNA or inhibiting or reducing the expression of target mRNA.
  • The route of administration is the path by which an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is brought into contact with the body. In general, methods of administering drugs and nucleic acids for treatment of a mammal are well known in the art and can be applied to administration of the compositions described herein. The expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to the herein described targeting ligands can be administered via any suitable route in a preparation appropriately tailored to the particular route. Thus, herein described pharmaceutical compositions can be administered by injection, for example, intravenously, intramuscularly, intracutaneously, subcutaneously, intraarticularly, or intraperitoneally. In some embodiments, there herein described pharmaceutical compositions and be administered via inhalation.
  • The pharmaceutical compositions including an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to a targeting ligand described herein can be delivered to a cell, group of cells, tumor, tissue, or subject using oligonucleotide delivery technologies known in the art. In general, any suitable method recognized in the art for delivering a nucleic acid molecule (in vitro or in vivo) can be adapted for use with a herein described compositions. For example, delivery can be by local administration, (e.g., direct injection, implantation, or topical administering), systemic administration, or subcutaneous, intravenous, intraperitoneal, or parenteral routes, including intracranial (e.g., intraventricular, intraparenchymal and intrathecal), intramuscular, transdermal, airway (aerosol), nasal, oral, rectal, or topical (including buccal and sublingual) administration. In certain embodiments, the compositions are administered by subcutaneous or intravenous infusion or injection.
  • Accordingly, in some embodiments, the herein described pharmaceutical compositions may comprise one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients. In some embodiments, the pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be formulated for administration to a subject.
  • As used herein, a pharmaceutical composition or medicament includes a pharmacologically effective amount of at least one of the described therapeutic compounds and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients. Pharmaceutically acceptable excipients (excipients) are substances other than the Active Pharmaceutical ingredient (API, therapeutic product, e.g., F12 RNAi agent) that are intentionally included in the drug delivery system. Excipients do not exert or are not intended to exert a therapeutic effect at the intended dosage. Excipients may act to a) aid in processing of the drug delivery system during manufacture, b) protect, support or enhance stability, bioavailability or patient acceptability of the API, c) assist in product identification, and/or d) enhance any other attribute of the overall safety, effectiveness, of delivery of the API during storage or use. A pharmaceutically acceptable excipient may or may not be an inert substance.
  • Excipients include, but are not limited to: absorption enhancers, anti-adherents, anti-foaming agents, anti-oxidants, binders, buffering agents, carriers, coating agents, colors, delivery enhancers, delivery polymers, dextran, dextrose, diluents, disintegrants, emulsifiers, extenders, fillers, flavors, glidants, humectants, lubricants, oils, polymers, preservatives, saline, salts, solvents, sugars, suspending agents, sustained release matrices, sweeteners, thickening agents, tonicity agents, vehicles, water-repelling agents, and wetting agents.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions (where water soluble) or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersion. For intravenous administration, suitable carriers include physiological saline, bacteriostatic water, Cremophor ELTM (BASF, Parsippany, N.J.) or phosphate buffered saline (PBS). It should be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and should be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms such as bacteria and fungi. The carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol), and suitable mixtures thereof. The proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants. In many cases, it will be preferable to include isotonic agents, for example, sugars, polyalcohols such as mannitol, sorbitol, and sodium chloride in the composition. Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent which delays absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filter sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle which contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions, methods of preparation include vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • Formulations suitable for intra-articular administration can be in the form of a sterile aqueous preparation of the drug that can be in microcrystalline form, for example, in the form of an aqueous microcrystalline suspension. Liposomal formulations or biodegradable polymer systems can also be used to present the drug for both intra-articular and ophthalmic administration.
  • Formulations suitable for topical administration, including eye treatment, include liquid or semi-liquid preparations such as liniments, lotions, gels, applicants, oil-in-water or water-in-oil emulsions such as creams, ointments or pastes; or solutions or suspensions such as drops. Formulations for topical administration to the skin surface can be prepared by dispersing the drug with a dermatologically acceptable carrier such as a lotion, cream, ointment or soap. Useful are carriers capable of forming a film or layer over the skin to localize application and inhibit removal. For topical administration to internal tissue surfaces, the agent can be dispersed in a liquid tissue adhesive or other substance known to enhance adsorption to a tissue surface. For example, hydroxypropylcellulose or fibrinogen/thrombin solutions can be used to advantage. Alternatively, tissue-coating solutions, such as pectin-containing formulations can be used.
  • For inhalation treatments, inhalation of powder (self-propelling or spray formulations) dispensed with a spray can, a nebulizer, or an atomizer can be used. Such formulations can be in the form of a fine powder for pulmonary administration from a powder inhalation device or self-propelling powder-dispensing formulations. In the case of self-propelling solution and spray formulations, the effect can be achieved either by choice of a valve having the desired spray characteristics (i.e., being capable of producing a spray having the desired particle size) or by incorporating the active ingredient as a suspended powder in controlled particle size. For administration by inhalation, the compounds also can be delivered in the form of an aerosol spray from pressured container or dispenser which contains a suitable propellant, e.g., a gas such as carbon dioxide, or a nebulizer.
  • Systemic administration also can be by transmucosal or transdermal means. For transmucosal or transdermal administration, penetrants appropriate to the barrier to be permeated are used in the formulation. Such penetrants generally are known in the art, and include, for example, for transmucosal administration, detergents and bile salts. Transmucosal administration can be accomplished through the use of nasal sprays or suppositories. For transdermal administration, the active compounds typically are formulated into ointments, salves, gels, or creams as generally known in the art.
  • The active compounds can be prepared with carriers that will protect the compound against rapid elimination from the body, such as a controlled release formulation, including implants and microencapsulated delivery systems. Biodegradable, biocompatible polymers can be used, such as ethylene vinyl acetate, polyanhydrides, polyglycolic acid, collagen, polyorthoesters, and polylactic acid. Methods for preparation of such formulations will be apparent to those skilled in the art. Liposomal suspensions can also be used as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. These can be prepared according to methods known to those skilled in the art, for example, as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,522,811.
  • Oral or parenteral compositions can be formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage. Dosage unit form refers to physically discrete units suited as unitary dosages for the subject to be treated; each unit containing a predetermined quantity of active compound calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect in association with the required pharmaceutical carrier. The specification for the dosage unit forms of the disclosure are dictated by and directly dependent on the unique characteristics of the active compound and the therapeutic effect to be achieved, and the limitations inherent in the art of compounding such an active compound for the treatment of individuals. Furthermore, administration can be by periodic injections of a bolus, or can be made more continuous by intravenous, intramuscular or intraperitoneal administration from an external reservoir (e.g., an intravenous bag).
  • In conjunction with the methods of the present disclosure, pharmacogenomics (i.e., the study of the relationship between an individual's genotype and that individual's response to a foreign compound or drug) can be considered. Differences in metabolism of therapeutics can lead to severe toxicity or therapeutic failure by altering the relation between dose and blood concentration of the pharmacologically active drug. Thus, a physician or clinician can consider applying knowledge obtained in relevant pharmacogenomics studies in determining whether to administer a drug as well as tailoring the dosage and/or therapeutic regimen of treatment with the drug.
  • A pharmaceutical composition can contain other additional components commonly found in pharmaceutical compositions. Such additional components include, but are not limited to: anti-pruritics, astringents, local anesthetics, or anti-inflammatory agents (e.g., antihistamine, diphenhydramine, etc.). It is also envisioned that cells, tissues or isolated organs that express or comprise the herein defined RNAi agents may be used as “pharmaceutical compositions.” As used herein, “pharmacologically effective amount,” “therapeutically effective amount,” or simply “effective amount” refers to that amount of an RNAi agent to produce a pharmacological, therapeutic or preventive result.
  • Generally, an effective amount of an active compound will be in the range of from about 0.1 to about 100 mg/kg of body weight/day, e.g., from about 1.0 to about 50 mg/kg of body weight/day. In some embodiments, an effective amount of an active compound will be in the range of from about 0.25 to about 5 mg/kg of body weight per dose. In some embodiments, an effective amount of an active ingredient will be in the range of from about 0.5 to about 3 mg/kg of body weight per dose. The amount administered will also likely depend on such variables as the overall health status of the patient, the relative biological efficacy of the compound delivered, the formulation of the drug, the presence and types of excipients in the formulation, and the route of administration. Also, it is to be understood that the initial dosage administered can be increased beyond the above upper level in order to rapidly achieve the desired blood-level or tissue level, or the initial dosage can be smaller than the optimum.
  • For treatment of disease or for formation of a medicament or composition for treatment of a disease, the pharmaceutical compositions described herein including an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, such as an RNAi agent, linked to a targeting ligand, can be combined with an excipient or with a second therapeutic agent or treatment including, but not limited to: a second or other expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, a small molecule drug, an antibody, an antibody fragment, and/or a vaccine.
  • The described targeting ligands, when linked to expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds, and when added to pharmaceutically acceptable excipients or adjuvants, can be packaged into kits, containers, packs, or dispensers. The pharmaceutical compositions described herein may be packaged in pre-filled syringes or vials.
  • The above provided embodiments are now illustrated with the following, non-limiting examples.
  • EXAMPLES
  • The following examples are not limiting and are intended to illustrate certain embodiments disclosed herein.
  • Some of the abbreviations used in the following experimental details of the synthesis of the examples are defined below: h or hr=hour(s); min=minute(s); mol=mole(s); mmol=millimole(s); M=molar; μM=micromolar; g=gram(s); μg=microgram(s); rt or RT=room temperature; L=liter(s); mL=milliliter(s); wt=weight; Et2O=diethyl ether; THF=tetrahydrofuran; DMSO=dimethyl sulfoxide; EtOAc=ethyl acetate; Et3N or TEa=triethylamine; i-Pr2NEt or DIPEA or DIEA=diisopropylethylamine; CH2Cl2 or DCM=methylene chloride; CHCl3=chloroform; CDCl3=deuterated chloroform; CCl4=carbon tetrachloride; MeOH=methanol; EtOH=ethanol; DMF=dimethylformamide; BOC=t-butoxycarbonyl; CBZ=benzyloxycarbonyl; TBS=t-butyldimethylsilyl; TBSCl=t-butyldimethylsilyl chloride; TFA=trifluoroacetic acid; DMAP=4-dimethylaminopyridine; NaN3=sodium azide; Na2SO4=sodium sulfate; NaHCO3=sodium bicarbonate; NaOH=sodium hydroxide; MgSO4=magnesium sulfate; K2CO3=potassium carbonate; KOH=potassium hydroxide; NH4OH=ammonium hydroxide; NH4Cl=ammonium chloride; SiO2=silica; Pd—C=palladium on carbon; HCl=hydrogen chloride or hydrochloric acid; NMM=N-methylmorpholine; H2=hydrogen gas; KF=potassium fluoride; EDC-HCl═N-(3-Dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride; MTBE=methyl-tert-butyl ether; MeOH=methanol; Ar=argon; SiO2=silica; RT=retention time.
  • Additionally, examples of expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds suitable for use with the targeting ligands disclosed herein are set forth in various Tables in the Examples that follow. The following notations are used to indicate modified nucleotides for sequences set forth in the Tables disclosed herein:
      • N=2′-OH (unmodified) ribonucleotide (capital letter without f or d indication)
      • n=2′-OMe modified nucleotide
      • Nf=2′-fluoro modified nucleotide
      • dN=2′-deoxy nucleotides
      • NUNA=2′,3′-seco nucleotide mimics (unlocked nucleobase analogs)
      • NLNA=locked nucleotide
      • NfANA=2′-F-Arabino nucleotide
      • NM=2′-methoxyethyl nucleotide
      • X or Ab=abasic ribose
      • R=ribitol
      • (invdN)=inverted deoxyribonucleotide (3′-3′ linked nucleotide)
      • (invAb)=inverted abasic nucleotide
      • (invX)=inverted abasic nucleotide
      • (invn)=inverted 2′-OMe nucleotide
      • s=phosphorothioate linked nucleotide
      • vpdN=vinyl phosphonate deoxyribonucleotide
      • (3′OMen)=3′-OMe nucleotide
      • (5Me-Nf)=5′-Me, 2′-fluoro nucleotide
      • cPrp=cyclopropyl phosphonate
  • The compounds of the present disclosure can be made using synthetic chemical techniques known to those of skill in the art.
  • Example 1. Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compound Structure 1005b, 1004b, and 1002b
  • The Phosphoramidite-containing compound of Structure 1005b, Structure 1004b, and Structure 1002b were synthesized according to the following procedure, with the only difference being that 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8 herein) was used to synthesize compound Structure 1005b, 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8a herein) was used to synthesize compound Structure 1004b, and a mixture of 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8 herein) and 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8a herein) was used to synthesize compound Structure 1002b.
  • 1) Preparation of 2-amino-3-[4-(([(benzyloxy)carbonyl]amino)methyl)phenyl]propanoic acid (compound 2)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00172
  • Copper carbonate basic (1.67 grams (g), 7.59 mmol) was added slowly to a solution of 1 (7.00 g, 30.34 mmol) in water (100 mL). The resulting mixture was heated to 80° C. until dissolution was observed. The resulting dark blue solution was cooled to 25-30° C. and then treated with sodium hydroxide (1.21 g, 30.34 mmol) as a solution in water (10 mL), which resulted in precipitation of the amino acid-copper complex. The suspension was stirred for 1 hour at ambient temperature before being treated with a solution of benzyl chloroformate (6.21 g, 36.41 mmol) in THF (20 mL) dropwise over 5 minutes. The mixture was stirred for 1-2 h, then filtered. The wet cake was triturated in EtOAc and filtered once more to aid in removal of water. The blue solids were then added to a flask containing 200 mL water and treated with 10 mL concentrated HCl. The slurry was stirred for 18 h, then filtered and washed with water which resulted in 4.5 g of compound 2 as a white solid (45% yield, 95 AP). RT=5.8 min.
  • 2) Preparation of Tri-Acid (Compound 3)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00173
  • A slurry of 2 (6.00 g, 18.27 mmol) in 1.5M NaOH (100 mL) was heated to 60° C. at which point a solution was formed. The solution was then treated with a solution of bromoacetic acid (10.15 g, 73.20 mmol) dissolved in 1.5M NaOH (20 mL). The solution was stirred at 60° C. for 2 h (2=NMT 5% by HPLC). Once the reaction reached completion, the solution was cooled to 10° C. and 1M HCl was added until pH=1.7 was reached. The slurry was permitted to stand for 2-3 hours before being filtered and washed with deionized water. The solids were dried over vacuum resulting 3.01 g of tri-acid 3 (50%, 94 AP). RT=6.94 min.
  • 3) Preparation of TFP-Ester (Compound 4)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00174
  • A solution of 3 (3.00 g, 6.75 mmol) and 2,3,5,6-tetrafluorophenol (3.99 g, 24.30 mmol) in DCM (50 mL) was cooled to 10° C. and treated with N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (4.66 g, 24.30 mmol) in portions over 5 minutes. The solution was then allowed to warm to ambient temperature over 20 minutes and stirred for 3 h. After completion (3<10 AP), the reaction mixture was washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (20 mL), followed by brine (20 mL) and concentrated on a rotary evaporator. The resulting oil was purified on a flash column using a solvent gradient of 5-20% EtOAc/Hexanes resulting in 2.6 g of 4 as a colorless oil (40%, 94 AP). RT=12.99 min.
  • 4) Preparation of Amine Tosylate (Compound 5)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00175
  • To an appropriately sized pressure reactor charge (10 volumes) of THF followed by CbZ protected amine (1.0 eq, NAG-Z) and p-TsOH—H2O (1.0 equiv). Degas the solution with nitrogen three times. Charge 10% Pd/C (5.0 wt %) and then degas with nitrogen three times. Degas with hydrogen three times. Charge hydrogen to a pressure of 40 to 50 psi. Stir at 20 to 30° C. for three hours then degas with nitrogen three times and sample for IPC assay (spec≤0.5% NAG-Z, if spec not met then stir under H2 at 40 to 50 psi for 1 to 2 hr then reassay). Filter through diatomaceous earth to remove catalyst, washing with THF (4 volumes). Concentrate combined filtrate and wash under vacuum to about 2 volumes keeping Ti≤40° C. Dilute with DCM (3.8 volumes) and then reconcentrate to 2 volumes. Repeat DCM dilution and reconcentration then dilute with DCM (3.8 volumes). Sample for KF analysis (spec KF≤0.05%, if KF specification is not met then repeat concentration and dilution with DCM). After meeting the KF specification, concentrate the solution to a white foamy solid. Uncorrected yield of 100%. An analogous reaction substituting trifluoro acetic acid for p-TsOH—H2O may also be performed and can be used interchangeably.
  • 5) Preparation of Tri-NAG (Compound 6)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00176
  • The activated ester 4 (2.15 g, 2.41 mmol) and amine tosylate 5 (4.10 g, 6.75 mmol) were dissolved in dichloromethane (22 mL) and cooled to 10° C. The solution was treated with triethylamine (1.37 g, 13.54 mmol) dropwise over 5 minutes and then allowed to warm to ambient temperature and held for 2 h. The reaction mixture was washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (10 mL) followed by brine (10 mL). The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated on a rotary evaporator to give a colorless oil. After workup, ˜10% of the des-acyl impurity was found by HPLC. The impurity was re-acylated by stirring in neat acetic anhydride (90 mL) and triethylamine (6 mL) for 1 h. The acetic anhydride was then removed under reduced pressure and the resulting oil was re-dissolved in dichloromethane and washed with aqueous sodium bicarbonate. The solution was concentrated to an oil and purified via flash chromatography using gradient elution (2.5-25% MeOH/DCM) which gave 1.98 g 6 as a white solid (47%, 96 AP). RT=7.57 min; des-Acyl impurity=7.18 min.
  • 6) Preparation of Amine Salt (compound 7)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00177
  • The protected amine 6 (1.98 g, 1.06 mmol) and p-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (202 mg, 1.06 mmol) were dissolved in absolute ethanol (30 mL) and placed under nitrogen atmosphere. To the flask was added 5% palladium on carbon (198 mg, 0.106 mmol) and the flask was placed under vacuum and back-filled with hydrogen several times. Once under hydrogen atmosphere, the reaction was allowed to stir at ambient temperature and found to be complete within 4 h or until the starting material was non detected by HPLC. The catalyst was filtered through a bed of celite and the filtrate was passed through a 0.2 micron membrane filter to remove fine particulates. The solution was concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure which resulted in 2.01 g of 7 as a grey solid (100%, 98 AP). RT=5.82; p-toluenesulfonic acid RT=2.4 and 3.1 min.
  • 7) Preparation of Activated Linker (Compound 9 and 9a)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00178
  • The cis-4-hydroxy cyclohexylcarboxylic acid 8 (for synthesizing Structure 1005) (4.00 g, 27.7 mmol) and 2,3,5,6-tetrafluorophenol (5.53 g, 33.3 mmol) were dissolved in 24 mL dichloromethane and cooled to 0° C. [As noted above, while cis-4-hydroxy cyclohexylcarboxylic acid (compound 8) is used as the linker to formulate Structure 1005, trans-4 hydroxy cyclohexylcarboxylic acid (compound 8b) may be substituted for the cis-isomer, which leads to the synthesis of Structure 1004b, following the same procedure for the remainder of the synthesis:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00179
  • To this solution was added EDC-HCl (6.38 g, 33.3 mmol). The solution was allowed to warm to 22° C. and stirred for 12 hours. The reaction was quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (50 mL) and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with saturated brine (50 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. The drying agent was filtered and the solution was concentrated to approximately 20 mL, which slowly solidified (seed crystals will help). The solids were slurried in 5% MTBE/Hexanes (50 mL) and filtered to yield 5.6 g of product 9 in 69% yield and 95% purity.
  • 8) Linker Coupling (Preparation of Compound 10)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00180
  • NAG amine salt 7 (5.00 g, 2.88 mmol) and 2,3,5,6-tetrafluorophenyl cis-4-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylate 9 (1.68 g, 5.77 mmol) were dissolved in 25 mL dichloromethane and cooled to 0° C. To this solution was added triethylamine (1.60 mL, 11.55 mmol). The solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 5 hours with monitoring by HPLC. The reaction was quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (35 mL) and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with saturated brine (35 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. The drying agent was filtered and the solution was concentrated and purified via flash chromatography using gradient elution (0-20% MeOH/DCM) which gave 3.90 g of compound 10 as a white solid material (80%). RT=6.16 min. Alternatively, it is possible to perform a direct coupling of the linker without the use of the TFP ester, as shown in Example 2, below.
  • 9) Preparation of Compound 11
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00181
  • Compound 10 (1.87 g, 1.11 mmol) was dissolved in 20 mL dichloromethane and 2-cyanoethyl, N,N,N′,N′-tetraisopropyl phosphoramidite (0.84 g, 2.77 mmol) was added. The resulting solution was cooled to 5° C. To this solution was added 4,5-dicyanoimidiazole (0.026 g, 0.22 mmol). The solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. The extent of conversion was then checked by HPLC (which indicated 2-% remaining starting material). Additional 2-cyanoethyl, N,N,N′,N′-tetraisopropyl phosphoramidite (0.14 g, 0.46 mmol) was added and the reaction stirred for an additional 2.5 h (no significant change was observed by HPLC). The reaction was quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (20 mL) and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with aqueous NaHCO3 (20 mL) and saturated brine (2×20 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. The drying agent was filtered and the solution was concentrated to give 2.34 g of compound 11 as a white solid material.
  • A 100 mg of the crude 11 was purified by flash column chromatography by first eluting the silica gel-packed column with 2% triethylamine in dichloromethane for 30 min, followed by loading the crude 11 on the column and purifying using gradient elution (0-20% of 2% triethylamine:methanol/2% triethylamine:dichloromethane). The final product compound 11 (which has the chemical structure of Structure 1005b defined herein) was eluted in 2% triethylamine:dichloromethane (Fraction 2) to give 80 mg of white solid material.
  • FIG. 1 shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 11 (Structure 1005b herein).
  • FIG. 1A shows 1H NMR spectra for the trans-isomer of compound 11 (Structure 1004b herein), following the alternative synthesis set forth in step 7, above.
  • Example 2. Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compound Structure 1008b 1) Preparation of Tri-tert-butyl N—[N-(Benzyloxycarbonyl)-L-γ-glutamyl]-L-glutamate (compound 14)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00182
  • To a nitrogen-flushed, 250-mL 3-neck round-bottomed flask equipped with a thermocouple, magnetic stir bar, nitrogen inlet, and powder funnel was added 12 (10.00 g, 29.64 mmol) followed by THF (100 mL, 10 vol.). The resulting solution was stirred, and N-methylmorpholine (7.82 mL, 7.19 g, 71.15 mmol, 2.4 equivalents) was added (KF of reaction mixture: 163 ppm).
  • The powder funnel was replaced with a rubber septum, and the mixture was cooled using an ice bath to 0° C. Isobutyl chloroformate (iBuCOCl, 3.85 mL, 4.05 g, 29.64 mmol, 1.0 equivalents) was added to the reaction mixture dropwise over 10 minutes via syringe, maintaining a pot temperature of less than 4.0° C. Following addition, the mixture was stirred 40 minutes more, and the septum was replaced with a powder funnel. To the reaction mixture was added 13 (8.767 g, 29.64 mmol, 1.0 equivalents) portion-wise over 15 minutes, maintaining a pot temperature of less than 4.0° C. (exothermic addition). Following addition of 13, the ice bath and powder funnel were removed, and the reaction was allowed to warm to ambient temperature over the course of the remaining steps. The clear, colorless solution was allowed to stand for 25 minutes following the addition of 13.
  • A sample of the reaction was taken 40 minutes after the start of addition of 13 and analyzed for percent conversion by RP-HPLC. There was found to be 23% remaining of 12, so after 60 minutes of reaction, additional iBuCOCl (1.16 mL, 1.21 g, 30 mol %) and 13 (2.63 g, 30 mol %) were added sequentially. The solution was allowed to stand for an additional 60 minutes, until a sample showed greater than 99% conversion by HPLC. Total reaction time was 2.5 hours from the start of the initial addition of 13.
  • The reaction solution was poured into a stirring solution of 0.5 M HCl(aq) (125 mL) chilled in an ice bath at 3° C. and stirred about 5 minutes. The quenched reaction mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (100 mL, 10 vol.; check to make sure the aqueous layer is acidic for complete removal of NMM), and the organic phase was washed with brine (100 mL, 10 vol.), dried over Na2SO4, filtered over a coarse fritted funnel into a 500-mL round-bottomed flask, and concentrated in vacuo, affording a thick colorless oil. The oil was dissolved in MTBE (100 mL, 10 vol.) and concentrated in vacuo, once again yielding a thick colorless oil.
  • To the stirring oil (˜600 rpm) was added hexanes (100 mL, 10 vol.). White haze appeared in the solution, which then disappeared upon further stirring. Seed crystals were added, and the mixture was allowed to stir for 40 minutes, during which time white crystals slowly formed.
  • Within 20 minutes, additional hexanes (50 mL, 5 vol.) was added. After 40 minutes, the slurry was filtered over a coarse fritted funnel, washed 3× with hexanes (˜10 mL each), and air-dried in the funnel for 1 hour, affording 14 as a fine white powder (15.64 g, 91%).
  • FIG. 2B shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 14.
  • 1) Preparation of N—[N-(Benzyloxycarbonyl)-L-γ-glutamyl]-L-glutamic acid (Compound 15)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00183
  • To a 3000-mL, 3-necked round-bottomed flask equipped with an overhead stirrer, powder funnel, thermocouple, and heating mantle was added 14 (72.57 g, 125.4 mmol) and formic acid (reagent grade, >95%, 1.45 L, 20 vol. equiv.). The powder funnel was replaced by a stopper with N2 inlet, and the resulting solution was heated to 45° C. and stirred for 1 hour, with monitoring by RP-HPLC. The reaction was deemed complete when less than 2.0 area % of mono-t-butyl esters remained.
  • A sample of the reaction was taken 60 minutes after the addition of formic acid, and the sample was analyzed by RP-HPLC for the percentage of mono-t-butyl esters remaining. The analysis showed that 1.8% mono-t-Bu esters remained after 90 minutes, and the reaction was cooled to room temperature.
  • The reaction was diluted with toluene and acetonitrile (1500 mL each), and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. Formic acid was azeotropically removed with 1:1 ACN:toluene (˜600 mL), and twice with ACN (˜500 mL each). The material was dried on high vacuum overnight to afford a white foamy solid (54.3 g, quantitative yield, 96.8 area % at 254 nm).
  • FIG. 2C shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 15.
  • 3) Preparation of Tri-NAG-Bis-Glu-NHZ (Compound 16)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00184
  • To a 1-liter round-bottomed flask was added NAG-amine p-tosylate salt (5, 59.19 g, 97.6 mmol, 4.13 equiv.) and Z-bis-Glu triacid (15, 10.01 g, 23.6 mmol purity corrected, 1.0 equiv.). The mixture was dissolved in acetonitrile (500 mL; KF of solution=1283 ppm) and concentrated in vacuo to remove water azeotropically. The residue was dissolved in fresh acetonitrile (400 mL) and transferred to a nitrogen-flushed 1-liter 3-neck round-bottomed flask containing a stir bar and equipped with a thermocouple. Water content was measured by KF (257 ppm).
  • To the stirring solution under nitrogen was added TBTU (28.20 g, 87.8 mmol, 3.7 equiv.) via a powder funnel. DIPEA (34.0 mL, 25.2 g, 8.0 equiv.) was added dropwise via syringe over 20 minutes, maintaining a reaction temperature below 25° C. (an exotherm of 5° C. was observed during the addition). The mixture was stirred for 2 hours from the start of DIPEA addition, with monitoring by HPLC. Analysis at 78 minutes showed complete consumption of starting material.
  • After two hours, the solvent was removed in vacuo. The resulting thick oil was dissolved in dichloromethane (1000 mL) and washed with 1.0 N HCl(aq) (3×500 mL) and saturated NaHCO3(aq) (3×500 mL). The organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford an off-white waxy solid (33.5 g).
  • Flash column chromatography was performed on an ISCO CombiFlash automated purification system using a 330-g ISCO RediSep Rf Gold silica column. The crude material was loaded as a solution in CHCl3 (˜200 mL). A ramped gradient of Eluent A: CHCl3; Eluent B: MeOH was utilized and a total of 36 fractions were collected (250-500 mL each). Product containing fractions were concentrated and yielded 18.75 g (97.0% purity) of 16. Mixed fractions yielded 12.2 g (78.8% purity) of 16.
  • FIG. 2D shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 16.
  • 4) Preparation of Tri-NAG-bis-Glu-NH2 (Compound 17)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00185
  • A 1000-mL 3-neck round-bottomed flask containing a stir bar was charged with methanol (200 mL, 13 vol.). To the stirring solvent was added compound 16 (15.44 g, 9.02 mmol purity-corrected), followed by additional methanol (200 mL, 13 vol.) and trifluoroacetic acid (1.40 mL, 18.1 mmol, 2.0 equiv.). The mixture was stirred about 10 minutes. To the mixture was added 10% Pd/C (50% wet basis, 1.547 g, 10% w/w). The headspace was flushed with hydrogen gas (balloon), and the mixture was allowed to stir at ambient temperature for 2 hours, with monitoring by RP-HPLC.
  • After 75 minutes, the reaction was sampled (100 μL) and mixed with 1:1 acetonitrile:H2O (900 μL) in a 1-mL syringe filter (10 mm, 0.1 μm GHP membrane). The HPLC chromatogram showed greater than 96 area % purity, with no remaining starting material. The reaction mixture was then flushed with nitrogen and filtered over a bed of Celite into a clean 1000-mL round-bottomed flask. The reaction vessel was rinsed with methanol (50 mL) and dichloromethane (50 mL), and the rinses were filtered also. The slightly cloudy filtrate was partially concentrated in vacuo. Additional rinses of the Celite bed were performed using methanol (50 mL) and dichloromethane (50 mL); these were combined with the residue and filtered over a 0.2-μm GHP membrane filter into another clean 1000-mL round-bottomed flask. The membrane was rinsed with acetonitrile (50 mL) so that the toluene byproduct could be removed azeotropically. The solution was concentrated in vacuo to afford 17 (14.15 g, 97.3 area % pure by HPLC) as an off-white foamy solid.
  • FIG. 2E shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 17.
  • 5) Preparation of Tri-NAG-bis-Glu-NH-linker (Compound 18)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00186
  • A 500 mL, 3-neck round-bottomed flask equipped with magnetic stirring, thermocouple, and nitrogen blanket was charged with 17 (93.7% pure, 20.00 g, 11.4 mmol) and dichloromethane (150 mL). To the stirring solution was added cis-4-hydroxycyclohexane-1-carboxylic acid (1.730 g, 12.0 mmol, 1.05 equiv.), followed by TBTU (4.036 g, 12.6 mmol, 1.10 equiv.). The solution was cooled to −9° C. using an ice-brine bath, and DIPEA (6.97 mL, 5.17 g, 40.0 mmol, 3.5 equiv.) was added dropwise over 7 minutes, keeping the internal temperature below −5° C. An exotherm of 1.7° C. was observed during the addition. Once the addition of DIPEA was complete, the reaction was stirred at −9° C. for 90 minutes, at which point HPLC analysis (Method B) showed complete consumption of 17.
  • After 110 minutes, the reaction was quenched by addition of saturated NH4Cl(aq) (400 mL). The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2×200 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with a 1:1 mixture of saturated NaHCO3(aq) and brine (400 mL), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to approximately 125 mL. A small amount of methanol was used to ensure solubility. The resulting oil was added in a thin stream to a 3-L round-bottomed flask containing stirring MTBE (1600 mL), forming a white precipitate. Rinses of the source flask with dichloromethane (˜20 mL) and MTBE (˜200 mL) were added to the slurry, which was then allowed to age for 1 hour before being vacuum-filtered over a 600-mL coarse glass fritted funnel. The wet cake was re-slurried in MTBE (2×200 mL) in the funnel, filtered, and dried on a high-vacuum line to constant mass, affording crude 18 as a white powder (16.22 g, 86% uncorrected yield).
  • Crude 18 (17.16 g, combined with a previous lot) was purified on an ISCO CombiFlash EZPrep automated purification system using a 330-g ISCO RediSep Rf Gold silica column. The crude material was loaded as a solution in 8% MeOH/CH2Cl2 (˜160 mL). A gradient of Eluent A: CH2Cl2; Eluent B: 50% MeOH:CH2Cl2 was utilized to produce 33 fractions. Product containing fractions were concentrated to afford 10.13 g (98.1% pure, 59% recovery) of 18. Mixed fractions were pooled to yield an additional 6.52 g (86.1% purity) of 18, which could be re-purified.
  • FIG. 2F shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 18.
  • 6) Preparation of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite (Compound 19)
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00187
  • Compound 18 (13.0 g, 7.87 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous dichloromethane (195 mL) and placed under nitrogen atmosphere. To this mixture, were added DIPEA (4.11 mL, 23.61 mmol) and a solution of 2-cyanoethyl-N,N-diisopropylchlorophosphorodiamidite (2.45 mL, 11.02 mmol) in anhydrous dichloromethane (5 mL) dropwise over 5 minutes. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 1 h while monitoring by HPLC (<1% SM remaining).
  • The reaction was quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (150 mL). The organic layer separated, washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (1×150 mL), and brine (1×150 mL), and dried with Na2SO4. The drying agent was filtered and the solution was concentrated and purified via flash chromatography by first treating the silica column with dichloromethane (+1% triethylamine) for 30 minutes followed by loading the crude final product, compound 19 (which has the chemical structure of Structure 1008 herein) on the column and purified using gradient elution (0-20% MeOH (+1% TEA)/CH2Cl2 (+1% TEA)) over 30 min which gave 11.1 g of compound 19 as a white solid material (76% yield, purity 96.6%).
  • FIG. 2 shows 31P NMR spectra for Compound 19. FIG. 2A shows 1H NMR spectra for Compound 19. FIG. 2 and FIG. 2A are both consistent with the structure of Compound 19 (Structure 1008b herein).
  • Example 3. Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compound Structure 1025 1) Preparation of Compound 21
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00188
  • To a solution of compound 20 (40 g, 221 mmol, 1.00 eq) in MeOH (350 mL) was added SOCl2 (52.5 g, 442 mmol, 32 mL, 2.00 eq) dropwise at 0-5° C. The solution was heated to 60° C. and stirred for 16 hrs. TLC (DCM/MeOH=5/1 with 5 drops HOAc, Rf=0.43) showed starting material consumed and LCMS (ET12452-6-P1A) showed product formed. The mixture was concentrated under vacuum to give crude compound 21 (52.4 g, crude) as a white solid. 1H NMR: (ET12452-6-plc DMSO Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 9.45 (s, 1H), 8.55 (br s, 3H), 7.00 (br d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 6.72 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 4.17 (br s, 1H), 3.67 (s, 3H), 3.01 (qd, J=14.2, 6.5 Hz, 2H).
  • 2) Preparation of Compound 22
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00189
  • To a solution of compound 21 (52.4 g, 226 mmol, 1.00 eq) in MeOH (230 mL) was added TEA (68.7 g, 679 mmol, 94 mL, 3.00 eq), Boc2O (59.2 g, 271 mmol, 62.4 mL, 1.20 eq) dropwise at 0° C., the mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 0.5 h, then stirred at 25° C. for 16 hrs. TLC (Petroleum ether/EtOAc=1/1, Rf=0.80) showed a new main spot formed and most starting material consumed. The mixture was concentrated, then purified by silica column (petroleum ether/EtOAc=1:1) to afford compound 22 (57.4 g, 86% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR: (ET12452-8-p1g CDCl3 Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 6.97 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 6.74 (br d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 5.65 (br s, 1H), 5.01 (br d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.49-4.59 (m, 1H), 3.72 (s, 3H), 2.92-3.09 (m, 2H), 1.43 (s, 9H).
  • 3) Preparation of Compound 23
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00190
  • To a solution of compound 22 (35 g, 119 mmol, 1.00 eq) dissolved in Acetone (170 mL) was added K2CO3 (21.3 g, 154 mmol, 1.30 eq) and BnBr (24.3 g, 142 mmol, 16.9 mL, 1.20 eq), the reaction mixture was heated to reflux (60° C.) for 14 hrs. TLC (Petroleum ether/EtOAc=3/1, Rf=0.80) showed starting material consumed and a new spot formed. H2O (500 mL) was added to the mixture at 5° C. and stirred for 0.5 h, then filtered and washed with H2O (80 mL*3), dried under vacuum to give compound 23 (43 g, 88% yield, 93% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR (ET12452-9-pla CDCl3 Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 7.31-7.46 (m, 5H), 7.05 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 6.91 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 4.97 (br d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.50-4.60 (m, 1H), 3.72 (s, 3H), 2.96-3.11 (m, 2H), 1.43 (s, 9H).
  • 4) Preparation of Compound 24
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00191
  • To a solution of compound 23 (43 g, 112 mmol, 1.00 eq) in EtOAc (215 mL) was added HCl/EtOAc (4 M, 215 mL, 7.71 eq) dropwise, the mixture was stirred for 9 hrs at 25° C. TLC (Petroleum ether/EtOAc=3/1, Rf=0.10) showed starting material consumed and a new pot formed. The mixture was filtered and washed with EtOAc (30 mL*3), dried under vacuum to give compound 24 (35 g, 97% yield, 99% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR: (ET12452-12-pla MeOD Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 7.40-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.34-7.39 (m, 2H), 7.29-7.33 (m, 1H), 7.17 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 2H), 7.00 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 2H), 5.09 (s, 2H), 4.26 (dd, J=7.3, 6.0 Hz, 1H), 3.81 (s, 3H), 3.07-3.23 (m, 2H).
  • 5) Preparation of Compound 26
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00192
  • Compound 24 (15.5 g, 48.2 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in CH3CN (40 mL) and NaOH (1.5 M, 70.6 mL, 2.20 eq), then compound 25 (13.4 g, 96.3 mmol, 6.94 mL, 2.00 eq) was added at 15° C., pH check: ˜2.5. Then 4 N NaOH was added until pH=13. The solution was heated at 70° C. After 30 min, the pH dropped below 6, again adjusted with 4 N NaOH (pH 11-13). Additional compound 25 (6.69 g, 48.2 mmol, 3.47 mL, 1.00 eq) was added portionwise (twice) and pH was adjusted each time to 11-13. The mixture was heated at 70° C. for 14 hrs. LCMS (ET12452-30-P1A, Rt=0.749 min) showed product formed. The mixture was cooled to 15° C., then adjusted to pH 1 with 4N HCl, filtered and washed with H2O (80 mL*2), dried. The residue was dissolved with THF (600 mL) and then concentrated for sixth with the batch of ET12452-27, ET12452-19, then stirred with DCM (500 mL) and filtered, the filter was dried to give compound 26 (35.5 g, 87% yield, 97% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR: (ET12452-30-p1r MeOD Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 7.40-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.36 (t, J=7.4 Hz, 2H), 7.27-7.32 (m, 1H), 7.17 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 6.91 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 2H), 5.49 (s, 1H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 3.71 (t, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 3.61 (s, 4H), 3.07 (dd, J=14.1, 7.5 Hz, 1H), 2.86-2.96 (m, 1H), 2.03 (s, 2H).
  • 6) Preparation of Compound 27
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00193
  • To the solution of compound 26 (15 g, 38.7 mmol, 1.00 eq), compound 26A (25.7 g, 155 mmol, 4.00 eq) in Pyridine (250 mL) was added EDCI (29.7 g, 155 mmol, 4.00 eq) at 5° C. The mixture was stirred at 30° C. for 12 hrs. LCMS (ET12452-59-P1A, Rt=1.053 min) showed mostly product. The mixture was concentrated, then dissolved with DCM (200 mL), washed with sat. NaHCO3 (80 mL*4), brine (80 mL*2), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica column (Petroleum ether/EtOAc=3:1, Rf=0.75) to afford product with compound 26A, then dissolved with DCM (200 mL), washed with sat. NaHCO3 (80 mL*4) and brine (80 mL*2), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give compound 27 (19.8 g, 61% yield) as an off-white gum. 1H NMR (ET12452-59-p1g CDCl3 Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 7.36-7.46 (m, 4H), 7.30-7.35 (m, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 6.97-7.07 (m, 3H), 6.94 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 4.13-4.26 (m, 5H), 3.25 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.06 (s, 1H), 1.25-1.29 (m, 1H)
  • 7) Preparation of Compound 27-2
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00194
  • Compound 27-1 (230 g, 1.53 mol, 205 mL, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in dry DCM (1.6 L) under an N2 atmosphere. The solution was cooled to 0° C. with an ice bath and TEA (232 g, 2.3 mol, 318 mL, 1.50 eq) was added. Subsequently TosCl (233 g, 1.22 mol, 0.80 eq) in DCM (500 mL) was added to the cooled reaction mixture. After addition, the solution was allowed to warm to 20° C. and was stirred for 5 hrs. TLC (petroleum ether/EtOAc=1:1, Rf=0.15) showed starting material consumed and HPLC (ET12452-15-P1L, Rt=1.71 min) showed 2 peaks. The reaction mixture was quenched by addition H2O (500 mL) at 0° C., and then the 2 reactions were extracted with CH2Cl2 (800 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with H2O (1 L) and brine (1 L), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica column (petroleum ether/EtOAc=1:1) to give compound 27-2 (338 g, 36% yield) as a yellow oil. 1H NMR: (ET12452-15-p1z1 CDCl3 Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 7.79 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.34 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), 4.12-4.19 (m, 2H), 3.67-3.72 (m, 4H), 3.60 (s, 4H), 3.55-3.58 (m, 2H), 2.44 (s, 3H), 2.32 (s, 1H)
  • 8) Preparation of Compound 27-3A
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00195
  • Compound 27-3-1 (230 g, 591 mmol, 1.00 eq) suspended in DCM (700 mL) at 20° C. and TMSOTf (197 g, 886 mmol, 160 mL, 1.50 eq) was added under N2. The color of the mixture changed to pink. The mixture was heated to 50° C. and stirred for 1.5 hrs. Then the reaction mixture was cooled to 20° C. and stirred for 14 hrs. TLC (DCM/MeOH=20:1, Rf=0.6) showed starting material consumed. The mixture was poured into aq. NaHCO3 (600 mL) at 0˜5° C. and stirred for 15 min. The color of the mixture changed to yellow. The mixture was extracted with DCM (500 mL), washed with aq.NaHCO3 (500 mL), water (500 mL*2) and brine (500 mL), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to afford compound 27-3A (189 g, crude, 92% purity) as a brown oil. 1H NMR: (ET12452-28-plc CDCl3 Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 6.00 (d, J=6.6 Hz, 1H), 5.47 (t, J=3.0 Hz, 1H), 4.91 (dd, J=7.5, 3.3 Hz, 1H), 4.17-4.28 (m, 2H), 4.08-4.14 (m, 1H), 3.97-4.03 (m, 1H), 2.13 (s, 3H), 2.05-2.09 (m, 9H)
  • 9) Preparation of Compound 27-4A
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00196
  • To a mixture of compound 27-3A (189 g, 574 mmol, 1.00 eq), compound 7-2 (140 g, 460 mmol, 0.80 eq) and 4A MOLECULAR SIEVE (150 g) in DCM (1.5 L) was added TMSOTf (63.8 g, 287 mmol, 51.9 mL, 0.50 eq) under N2 atmosphere, the mixture was stirred at 25° C. for 8 hrs. TLC(DCM/MeOH=20:1, Rf=0.46) showed starting material consumed and LCMS (ET12452-35-P1A, Rt=0.76 min) showed product formed. The mixture was filtered to remove the sieves, then quenched with cold NaHCO3 aqueous (1000 mL), extracted with DCM (800 mL*2), the separated organic layers were washed with sat. NaHCO3 (800 mL), H2O (800 mL*2) and brine (800 mL), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. Then purified by silica column (DCM/MeOH=20:1) to afford compound 27-4A (285 g, 73% yield) as a yellow oil. 1H NMR: (ET12452-35-p1g CDCl3 Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 7.81 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 7.37 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 6.30 (br d, J=9.5 Hz, 1H), 5.28-5.35 (m, 1H), 5.08 (dd, J=11.2, 3.3 Hz, 1H), 4.81 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 4.09-4.29 (m, 5H), 3.86-3.98 (m, 3H), 3.68-3.81 (m, 3H), 3.56-3.66 (m, 5H), 2.46 (s, 3H), 2.16 (s, 3H), 2.04 (s, 3H), 1.98 (s, 3H), 1.95 (s, 3H)
  • 10) Preparation of Compound 27-4
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00197
  • To a solution of compound 27-4A (285 g, 450 mmol, 1.00 eq) in DMSO (1.4 L) was added NaN3 (38.1 g, 586 mmol, 1.30 eq) at 10° C., the mixture was stirred at 60° C. for 16 hrs. LCMS (ET12452-37-P1A, Rt=0.67 min) showed product formed and starting material consumed. The mixture was poured into H2O (1500 mL), extracted with EtOAc (1 L*5), washed with H2O (800 mL*3) and brine (800 mL*3), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give compound 27-4 (168 g, crude) as a red oil. 1H NMR (ET12452-37-plc CDCl3 Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 6.12 (br d, J=9.4 Hz, 1H), 5.32 (d, J=2.9 Hz, 1H), 5.06 (dd, J=11.3, 3.4 Hz, 1H), 4.78 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 4.08-4.27 (m, 5H), 3.82-3.94 (m, 3H), 3.61-3.77 (m, 10H), 3.45-3.50 (m, 2H), 2.16 (s, 3H), 2.05 (d, J=1.5 Hz, 5H), 1.99 (d, J=4.5 Hz, 6H), 1.26 (t, J=7.2 Hz, 2H)
  • 11) Preparation of Compound 27A
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00198
  • To a solution of compound 27-4 (79 g, 156 mmol, 1.00 eq) in EtOAc/MeOH (4:1) (640 mL) was added Pd(OH)2/C (7.9 g), the mixture was stirred at 15° C. for 4 hrs under H2 (30 psi) atmosphere. TLC (DCM/MeOH=20:1) showed starting material consumed and LCMS (ET12452-53-P1C, Rt=2.55 min) showed product formed. The 2 parallel reactions were filtered with Celite and washed with DCM (500 mL*5) and MeOH (200 mL*3), concentrated to give compound 27A (140 g, crude) as a dark-brown oil. 1H NMR: (ET12452-53-plc CDCl3 Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 7.02 (br d, J=9.3 Hz, 1H), 5.29-5.34 (m, 1H), 5.09 (dd, J=11.2, 3.3 Hz, 1H), 4.80 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 4.09-4.24 (m, 3H), 3.82-3.95 (m, 3H), 3.52-3.70 (m, 10H), 2.91 (td, J=5.2, 2.8 Hz, 1H), 2.15 (s, 3H), 2.05 (s, 4H), 1.98 (d, J=6.4 Hz, 6H).
  • 12) Preparation of Compound 28
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00199
  • TEA (12.1 g, 119 mmol, 16.5 mL, 5.00 eq) was added to a stirred solution containing compound 27 (19.8 g, 23.8 mmol, 1.00 eq) and compound 27A (57 g, 119 mmol, 5.00 eq) in DCM (160 mL). It was stirred at 30° C. for 16 hrs. LCMS (ET12452-64-P1A, Rt=1.21 min) showed product formed. Diluted with DCM (100 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3/saturated brine (1:1, 2×80 mL). Organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give crude product as a brown solid.
  • The crude product was dissolved in Ac2O (42 mL), CH3CN (62.5 mL) and Py (82.3 g, 1.04 mol, 84 mL, 23.96 eq), the mixture was stirred at 25° C. for 12 hrs. HPLC(ET12452-65-P1A, Rt=2.54 min) showed most product. CH3CN was evaporated off, then diluted with DCM (400 mL) and washed with sat. NaHCO3 (100 mL*4). Organic layer was separated and washed with 0.1M HCl/saturated brine (1:1, 100 mL*4), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica column (DCM/MeOH=10:1, Rf=0.45) to give product, then further purified by p-HPLC (column: Phenomenex Gemini C18 250*50 mm*10 um; mobile phase: [water (10 mM NH4HCO3)-ACN]; B %: 25%-55%, 23 min) to give compound 28 (28.8 g, 58% yield, 98% purity) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (ET12452-65-p1j DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 8.00-8.09 (m, 3H), 7.81 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 3H), 7.29-7.45 (m, 5H), 7.10 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 2H), 6.89 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 5.21 (d, J=3.3 Hz, 3H), 5.04 (s, 2H), 4.97 (dd, J=11.2, 3.3 Hz, 3H), 4.54 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 3H), 4.02 (s, 9H), 3.83-3.92 (m, 3H), 3.73-3.81 (m, 3H), 3.53-3.61 (m, 4H), 3.44-3.52 (m, 17H), 3.42 (br d, J=4.4 Hz, 2H), 3.35-3.40 (m, 6H), 3.07-3.27 (m, 11H), 2.74-2.87 (m, 2H), 2.09 (s, 9H), 1.99 (s, 10H), 1.89 (s, 9H), 1.77 (s, 9H).
  • 13) Preparation of Compound 29
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00200
  • To a solution of compound 28 (9.7 g, 5.48 mmol, 1.00 eq) in THF (250 mL) was added dry Pd/C (5.5 g, 5.48 mmol), the mixture was stirred at 40° C. for 6.5 hrs under H2 atmosphere (50 psi). TLC (DCM/MeOH=10:1, Rf=0.3) showed starting material consumed. The 2 parallel reactions were filtered and washed with THF (300 mL*4) and DCM (200 mL*3), concentrated. The residue was purified by p-HPLC (column: Phenomenex luna C18 250*50 mm*10 um; mobile phase: [water (0.1% TFA)-ACN]; B %: 15/6-45%, 20 min) with the batch of ET12452-78 to afford compound 29 (14 g, 63% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR: (ET12452-80-p1j DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 9.19 (s, 1H), 7.99-8.10 (m, 3H), 7.83 (d, J=9.3 Hz, 3H), 6.95 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 6.62 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 2H), 5.76 (s, 2H), 5.21 (d, J=3.3 Hz, 3H), 4.97 (dd, J=11.2, 3.3 Hz, 3H), 4.54 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 3H), 4.03 (s, 9H), 3.83-3.92 (m, 3H), 3.73-3.81 (m, 3H), 3.53-3.61 (m, 4H), 3.44-3.52 (m, 16H), 3.43 (br d, J=4.4 Hz, 3H), 3.36-3.39 (m, 3H), 3.26-3.33 (m, 4H), 3.05-3.24 (m, 9H), 2.65-2.82 (m, 2H), 2.10 (s, 9H), 2.00 (s, 9H), 1.89 (s, 9H), 1.77 (s, 9H).
  • 14) Preparation of Compound 30
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00201
  • Compound 29 (8 g, 4.77 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in DCM (65 mL) and compound 29A (2.88 g, 9.54 mmol, 3 mL, 2.00 eq) was added. The resulting solution was cooled to 5° C. To this solution was added 2H-tetrazole (0.45 M, 11.7 mL, 1.10 eq). The solution was allowed to warm to 15° C. and stirred for 3.5 hrs. TLC (DCM/MeOH=5:1, Rf=0.52) showed starting material consumed and HPLC (ET12452-82-P1A, Rt=2.69 min) showed product formed. Diluted with DCM (50 mL), quenched with NaHCO3 (30 mL), the aqueous was extracted with DCM (30 mL*2), the combined organic layers was washed with sat. NaHCO3 (30 mL*2), H2O (30 mL) and brine (30 mL*2), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was dissolved with DCM (30 mL), then Hexane (150 mL) was added dropwise at 0° C. and stirred for 15 min, then chilled, the organic layer was poured off and the oil was dissolved with DCM (30 mL) again and added Hexane (150 mL) dropwise, the procedure was repeated for 7 times, dried under vacuum to afford compound 30 (5.5 g, 55% yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (ET12452-83-p1b DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 7.97-8.09 (m, 3H), 7.78 (d, J=9.3 Hz, 3H), 7.06 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 6.86 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 2H), 5.73 (s, 2H), 5.18 (d, J=3.3 Hz, 3H), 4.94 (dd, J=11.1, 3.4 Hz, 3H), 4.51 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 3H), 3.99 (s, 9H), 3.79-3.89 (m, 4H), 3.70-3.78 (m, 4H), 3.59-3.69 (m, 2H), 3.49-3.58 (m, 4H), 3.44 (s, 16H), 3.40 (br d, J=4.2 Hz, 3H), 3.32-3.37 (m, 5H), 3.24-3.28 (m, 1H), 3.05-3.22 (m, 9H), 2.78 (br t, J=5.8 Hz, 4H), 2.07 (s, 9H), 1.96 (s, 9H), 1.86 (s, 9H), 1.74 (s, 9H), 1.15 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 6H), 1.09 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 6H).
  • FIG. 3 shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 30 (Structure 1025b herein).
  • Example 4: Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compound Structure 1014b 1) Preparation of Compound 32
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00202
  • A solution of compound 31 (24.71 g, 87.85 mmol, 1.00 eq), compound 31A, EDCI (39.07 g, 203.82 mmol, 2.32 eq), Pyridine (19.39 g, 245.11 mmol, 19.79 mL, 2.79 eq) in ACN (260.00 mL) was stirred at 25° C. for 2 hrs. TLC (petroleum ether/ethyl acetate=1/1, desired product; Rf=0.7) showed desired product formed. The mixture was added to 300 mL EtOAc, washed with NaHCO3 (100 mL*2), 100 mL brine, dried with Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give a residue. The crude product was purified with a silica column (petroleum ether/ethyl acetate=100/1˜3/1) to give compound 32 (60.00 g, 79.25 mmol, 90.20% yield, 97.19% purity) as a yellow oil. 1H NMR: (ET12600-89-pla DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ ppm 7.52 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.27-7.38 (m, 5H), 4.99 (s, 2H), 4.26-4.42 (m, 3H), 3.80-4.15 (m, 8H), 2.27 (br s, 2H), 1.78-1.88 (m, 1H), 1.66 (br dd, J=14.4, 7.2 Hz, 1H), 1.37-1.41 (m, 35H)
  • 2) Preparation of Compound 33
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00203
  • A solution of compound 32 (45.00 g, 61.15 mmol, 1.00 eq) in FORMIC ACID (800.00 mL) was stirred at 45° C. for 6 hr. LCMS (et12600-90-pla, MS=511) showed the desired product formed. The mixture was concentrated to give a residue. The residue was washed with 1000 mL DCM to give compound 33 (30.00 g, 54.71 mmol, 89.47% yield, 93.27% purity) as a white solid. 1H NMR (ET12600-90-pla DMSO Bruker_B_400 MHz) δ 12.75 (br s, 3H), 7.53 (br d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.29-7.38 (m, 5H), 4.99 (d, J=3.6 Hz, 2H), 4.27-4.38 (m, 2H), 4.12 (br s, 2H), 3.84-4.07 (m, 6H), 2.30 (br t, J=7.2 Hz, 2H), 2.07 (s, 1H), 1.59-1.88 (m, 2H), 1.39 (t, J=5.6 Hz, 1H).
  • 3) Preparation of Compound 34
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00204
  • To a solution of compound 33 (15 g, 29.33 mmol, 1.00 eq), compound 33A (29.22 g, 175.98 mmol, 6.00 eq), Pyridine (11.60 g, 146.65 mmol, 11.84 mL, 5.00 eq) in ACN (90 mL) was added EDCI (28.11 g, 146.65 mmol, 5.00 eq), then the mixture was stirred for 25° C. for 1 hrs. TLC (petroleum ether/ethyl acetate=3/1) showed desired product formed. The mixture was added 500 mL DCM, washed with NaHCO3 (200 mL*2), 100 mL brine, dried with Na2SO4, filtered and concentrate to give a residue. Purified with silica column (petroleum ether/ethyl acetate=4/1) to give compound 34 (28 g) as a yellow solid.
  • 4) Preparation of Compound 35
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00205
  • To a solution of compound 34 (16.57 g, 15.01 mmol, 1 eq), compound 34A in DCM (140 mL) was added TEA (9.12 g, 90.08 mmol, 12.49 mL, 6.00 eq), then the mixture was stirred at 25° C. for 16 hrs. LCMS (et12600-98-p1g) showed desired product formed. The mixture was poured onto 200 mL DCM, washed with 100 mL NaHCO3, 100 mL brine, dried with Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give a residue. Purified with prep-HPLC (column: Phenomenex Gemini C18 250*50 10 u; mobile phase: [water (10 mM NH4HCO3)-ACN]; B %: 15%-45%, 20 min) to give compound 5 (11 g, 4.65 mmol, 30.98% yield, 99.5% purity) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR: (ET12600-98-p1a1 DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 8.65-8.71 (m, 1H), 8.51 (br s, 1H), 8.18-8.25 (m, 1H), 8.11 (br s, 1H), 7.80 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 4H), 7.47 (br d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.28-7.40 (m, 5H), 5.75 (s, 4H), 5.22 (d, J=3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.95-5.03 (m, 6H), 4.55 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 4H), 3.98-4.06 (m, 15H), 3.88 (dt, J=11.2, 8.8 Hz, 7H), 3.78 (dt, J=10, 5.2 Hz, 5H), 3.54-3.62 (m, 6H), 3.46-3.53 (m, 25H), 3.41 (q, J=5.6 Hz, 9H), 3.23 (br dd, J=11.6, 5.6 Hz, 8H), 2.10 (s, 12H), 2.00 (s, 12H), 1.89 (s, 12H), 1.77 (s, 12H).
  • 5) Preparation of Compound 36
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00206
  • To a solution of compound 35 (10 g, 4.25 mmol, 1 eq), TFA (484.52 mg, 4.25 mmol, 314.62 uL, 1 eq) in MeOH (10 mL) was added 10% Pd(OH)2/C (3.00 g), then the mixture was stirred at 20° C. for 4 hrs under H2 (50 Psi). LCMS (et12600-107-pla, Rt=2.195) showed desired product formed the mixture was filtered and concentrated to give compound 36 (8 g, 3.60 mmol, 84.84% yield) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (ET12600-107-pla DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 8.68 (br t, J=5.2 Hz, 1H), 8.46 (br t, J=5.2 Hz, 1H), 8.21-8.27 (m, 1H), 8.15 (br d, J=5.6 Hz, 2H), 7.84 (br d, J=9.2 Hz, 4H), 5.22 (d, J=3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.98 (dd, J=11.2, 3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.56 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 4H), 4.24 (br s, 1H), 3.99-4.14 (m, 23H), 3.84-3.94 (m, 7H), 3.74-3.83 (m, 5H), 3.55-3.62 (m, 5H), 3.51 (s, 25H), 3.38-3.46 (m, 9H), 3.20-3.30 (m, 9H), 3.17 (d, J=5.2 Hz, 14H), 2.11 (s, 12H), 2.00 (s, 13H), 1.89 (s, 12H), 1.78 (s, 12H).
  • 6) Preparation of Compound 37
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00207
  • For batches was in parallel. To a solution of compound 36 (2 g, 857.18 umol, 1.00 eq, TFA), compound 36A (626.23 mg, 2.14 mmol, 2.50 eq) in DCM (6 mL) was added TEA (312.26 mg, 3.09 mmol, 427.75 uL, 3.60 eq), then the mixture was stirred at 25° C. for 16 hrs. LCMS showed desired product formed. All the reaction mixture was combined, dissolved in 200 mL DCM, poured onto 30 mL NaHCO3, washed with 30 mL brine, dried with Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give a residue. Purified with prep-HPLC (column: Phenomenex Gemini C18 250*50 10 u; mobile phase: [water (10 mM NH4HCO3)-ACN]; B %: 15%-45%, 20 min) to give compound 37 (7.5 g, 3.20 mmol, 93.27%/yield) as a white solid. 1H NMR (ET12600-111-pla DMSO Varian_D_400 MHz) δ 8.66 (s, 1H), 8.51 (br s, 1H), 8.20 (s, 1H), 8.08 (s, 1H), 7.91 (br d, J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 7.80 (di, J=9.2 Hz, 4H), 5.22 (di, J=3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.98 (dd, J=11.2, 3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.55 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 4H), 4.47 (br s, 1H), 4.30 (s, 1H), 4.25 (d, J=3.2 Hz, 1H), 4.03 (s, 11H), 3.97 (br s, 2H), 3.84-3.92 (m, 7H), 3.73-3.82 (m, 6H), 3.55-3.62 (m, 5H), 3.47-3.54 (m, 24H), 3.41 (q, J=5.6 Hz, 9H), 3.23 (br dd, J=11.2, 5.6 Hz, 8H), 2.19 (br s, 1H), 2.10 (s, 12H), 2.00 (s, 13H), 1.89 (s, 12H), 1.77 (s, 13H), 1.61 (brs, 3H), 1.40 (br d, J=11.2 Hz, 4H).
  • 8) Preparation of Compound 38
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00208
  • Compound 37 (4.4 g, 1.88 mmol, 1 eq) in DCM (26.4 mL) and compound 37A (1.13 g, 3.75 mmol, 1.19 mL, 2 eq) was added. The resulting solution was cooled to 5° C. To this solution was added 2H-tetrazole (0.45 M, 4.59 mL, 1.1 eq). The solution was allowed to warm to 20° C. and stirred for 2 hr. The mixture was dissolved in 100 mL DCM, quenched with 20 mL NaHCO3, extracted with DCM (50 mL*2), washed with 20 mL NaHCO3, 20 mL brine, dried with Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give a residue. The residue was dissolved with DCM (25 mL, 0.2% TEA), then Hexane (125 mL, 0.2%/TEA) was added dropwise at 0° C. and stirred for 15 min, then chilled, the organic layer was poured off and the oil was dissolved with DCM (30 mL) a gained and added Hexane (150 mL) dropwise, the procedure was repeated for 3 times, dried under vacuum. 20 mL of DCM was added to the white solid, it was dried under vacuum at 30° C. to give 38 (4.8 g, 1.83 mmol, 67.34% yield, 97.15% purity) as a white solid. LCMS: [M-iPr2N]+/2, 1222.8. 1H NMR: (DMSO, Varian_400 MHz) δ 8.67 (br s, 1H), 8.52 (br s, 1H), 8.20 (br s, 1H), 8.08 (br s, 1H), 7.98 (br d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.79 (br d, J=9.2 Hz, 4H), 5.21 (d, J=3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.98 (dd, J=11.2, 3.2 Hz, 4H), 4.55 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 4H), 4.47 (br s, 1H), 4.29 (br d, J=17.6 Hz, 1H), 3.94-4.11 (m, 16H), 3.83-3.94 (m, 8H), 3.78 (br dd, J=10.4, 5.2 Hz, 6H), 3.64-3.74 (m, 3H), 3.54-3.63 (m, 8H), 3.50 (br s, 26H), 3.36-3.44 (m, 9H), 3.14-3.29 (m, 9H), 2.75 (t, J=5.6 Hz, 2H), 2.15-2.27 (m, 4H), 2.10 (s, 13H), 2.00 (s, 13H), 1.82-1.95 (m, 15H), 1.77 (s, 14H), 1.59-1.73 (m, 4H), 1.45 (br d, J=14.4 Hz, 4H), 1.14 (d, J=6.4 Hz, 12H).
  • FIG. 4 shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 38 (Structure 1014b herein).
  • Example 5: Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite Compound Structure 1006b and 1007b
  • The phosphoramidite-containing compound of Structure 1006b and Structure 1007b were synthesized according to the following same procedure, with the only difference being that 4-cis-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8 herein) was used to synthesize Structure 1006b, and 4-trans-hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (compound 8a herein) was used to synthesize Structure 1007b.
  • 1) Preparation of Compound 41
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00209
  • A solution of Z-Glu-(OtBu)-OH 39 (445 mg, 1.32 mmol), Di-tert-butyl iminodiacetate 40 (340 mg, 1.39 mmol), EDC (319 mg, 1.66 mmol, 1.23 eq) and Py (3 eq, 0.33 mL) in ACN (3 mL) was stirred at RT for 1 h, diluted with ethyl acetate and washed with NaHCO3 (2×). Organic layer was dried MgSO4 and evaporated. Next the crude was dissolved in DCM (5 mL) and TFA (5 mL) was added. It was stirred at RT for 16 h and then evaporated. Ethyl acetate was added and evaporated 4× until foam/precipitate was formed. The crude 41 was used directly in TFP activation step. Rt=3.78 min, 90% pure. LCMS (ES, M/z): 379.0 [M+H]+.
  • 2) Preparation of Compound 42
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00210
  • A solution of crude tri-acid 41 (˜1.30 mmol), TFP (7 eq, 9.10 mmol, 1.51 g), TEA (4 eq, 0.723 mL) and EDC (3.3 eq, 4.29 mmol, 0.82 g) in ACN (3.5 mL) was stirred at RT for 1 h, diluted with DCM (250 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3 (2×100 mL). Organic phase was dried over Na2SO4, concentrated and purified on silica column. Product activated tri-TFP ester was eluted with AcOEt in hex (5-20%) to give 550 mg of product, with a trace of TFP. R=7.06 min.
  • TEA (400 uL, 2.9 mmol) was added to a stirred solution containing tri-TFP ester (540 mg, 0.642 mmol) and GalNac-Peg3-NH2×TsOH (2.89 mmol, 1.88 g) in DCM (6 mL). It was stirred at RT for 16 h, diluted with DCM (200 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3/saturated brine (1:1, 2×150 mL). Organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, evaporated leaving a white solid. The solid was dissolved in DCM and purified on silica column. Elution with MeOH in DCM (0-10%) gave 748 mg, 95.4% pure and ˜100 mg, 80% pure tri-GalNAc 42, 36% yield, 2-steps. LCMS (ES, M/z): 1777.5 [M]+, Rt=4.67 min.
  • 3) Preparation of Compound 43
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00211
  • 10% Pd/C, activated matrix (30 mg) was added to a solution of Cbz protected amine 42 (715 mg, 0.402 mmol) and TsOH (74.5 mg, 0.402 mmol) in THF (4 mL) and TFE (4 mL). Next, hydrogen atmosphere (balloon) was established by pulling vacuum and back filling with hydrogen. It was stirred under hydrogen atmosphere for 24 h, filtered through Celite, washed with DCM (2×10 mL) and evaporated leaving the alcohol C as a white solid. LCMS (ES, M/z): 1644.2 [M+H]+, Rt=4.67 min.
  • The deprotected intermediate (0.4 mmol) and TFP ester of 4-cis-Hydroxycyclohexanecarboxylic acid (350 mg, 1.20 mmol) ware dissolved in DCM (2.5 mL) and TEA (3.5 eq, 0.195 mL) was added. It was stirred at RT for 16 h. Next it was diluted with DCM (100 mL), washed with saturated NaHCO3/saturated brine (1:1, 100 mL×2). Organic phase was dried over Na2SO4, concentrated and purified on silica column. Product was eluted with MeOH in DCM (2-20%) to give 430 mg of >95% pure 43, 61% yield. Rt=4.20 min. LCMS: (ES, M/z): 1771.26 [M+H]+.
  • 4) Preparation of Compound 44
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00212
  • 2-Cyanoethyl N,N,N′,N′-tetraisopropylphosphorodiamidite (1.5 eq, 110 uL, 0.343 mmol) was added at 0° C. to a stirred solution of alcohol 43 (405 mg, 0.229 mmol, vacuum dried) and tetrazole (0.50 eq, 0.25 mL, 0.112 mmol, 0.45M in ACN) in anhydrous DCM (2.4 mL). It was stirred at RT for 1, and additional tetrazole (0.125 ml) and 2-Cyanoethyl N,N,N′,N′-tetraisopropylphosphorodiamidite (0.10 mL) were added. Stirring continued for 30 min, next it was diluted with DCM (200 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3/saturated brine (1:1, 200 mL). Organic layer was dried over Na2SO4/MgSO4, evaporated, than dissolved in anhydrous DCM and evaporated again leaving a white solid 44, 408 mg, HPLC purity 92%, 83% yield. LCMS: (ES, M/z): 1870.4 [M-iPr2N]+.
  • FIG. 5 shows 1H NMR spectra for compound 44 (Structure 1007b herein).
  • Example 6: Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compound Structure 1027b 1) Preparation of Compound 45
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00213
  • TEA (5.3 mmol, 0.735 mL, 4.00 eq) was added to a stirred solution containing compound 27 (1.1 g, 1.32 mmol, 1.00 eq) and compound 45A (3.20 g, 5.29 mmol, 4.00 eq) in DCM (9 mL). It was stirred at 30° C. for 16 hrs. Diluted with DCM (100 mL) and washed with saturated NaHCO3/saturated brine. Organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated to give crude product as a brown solid.
  • The crude product was dissolved in Ac2O (3 mL), CH3CN (6 mL) and Py (6 mL) and the mixture was stirred at 25° C. for 16 hrs. CH3CN was evaporated off, then it was diluted with DCM and washed with sat. NaHCO3 four times. Organic layer was separated and washed with 0.1M HCl/saturated brine, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica column (DCM/MeOH=10:1, Rf=0.45) to give product 45 (1.47 g, 68% yield, 96% purity) as a white solid.
  • 4) Preparation of Compound 46
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00214
  • To a solution of compound 45 (1.425 g, 0.871 mmol, 1.00 eq) in THF/TFE (1:1, 5 mL) was added 10% Pd/C (24 mg), and the mixture was stirred at 40° C. for 30 h under H2 atmosphere. TLC (DCM/MeOH=10:1, Rf=0.3) showed starting material consumed. It was filtered, washed with THF (5 mL×3), DCM (5 mL×3) and concentrated. The residue was purified on silica column. Eluted with DCM/MeOH to give compound 46 (1.013 g, 75% yield, 95% pure) as a white solid. LCMS: (ES, M/z): 1547.5 [M+H]+.
  • 5) Preparation of Compound 47
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00215
  • Compound 46 (970 mg, 0.627 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in DCM (4.2 mL) and compound 46A (0.941 mmol, 0.298 mL, 1.5 eq) was added. The resulting solution was cooled to 5° C. and dicyanoimidazole (DCI) (23.1 mg, 0.188 mmol, 0.3 eq). The solution was allowed to warm to 15° C. and stirred for 2 hrs. TLC (DCM/MeOH=5:1, Rf=0.52) showed starting material consumed and HPLC showed product formed. It was diluted with DCM (50 mL), washed with sat. NaHCO3 (30 mL), H2O (30 mL) and brine (30 mL), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was dissolved with DCM (2 mL) and added to hexane (120 mL). The white precipitate was filtered off to afford compound 47 (0.975 g, 93% pure, 82% yield) as a white solid. LCMS: (ES, M/z): 1747.5 [M+H]+.
  • FIG. 6 shows 1H NMR spectra for Compound 47 (Structure 1027b herein).
  • Example 7. Synthesis of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compound Structure 1026b 1) Preparation of Tri-Acid 49
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00216
  • To a solution of 4-bromo-DL-phenylalanine hydrochloride (5.0 g, 17.8 mmol) in 1.5M NaOH (100 mL) was added bromoacetic acid (8.17 g, 58.8 mmol). The solution was heated to 60° C. for 1 hour, keeping the pH above 12 by addition of sodium hydroxide pellets. Upon completion, the reaction was cooled to 15° C. and the pH was adjusted to 1.75-2.00 and the oily suspension was aged for 2 hours until a filterable solid was observed. The solids were filtered and washed with water several times resulting in isolation of a white solid (6.0 g, 93% yield).
  • 2) Preparation of Biaryl Tri-Acid 50
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00217
  • The aryl bromide 49 (4.2 g, 11.6 mmol) and boronic acid 50 (2.8 g, 12.2 mmol) were dissolved in a 1:1 mixture of DMF/water (168 mL) and degassed for 10 minutes. The solution was treated with potassium carbonate (8.0 g, 116.2 mmol) and PdCl2 (dppf) (0.476 g, 0.6 mmol) and the reaction vessel was placed under nitrogen atmosphere and heated to 40° C. for 5 hours. Upon completion, the pH was adjusted to 12 and the aqueous phase was washed 2× (20 mL) ethyl acetate. The pH was then adjusted to 1.75-2.00 and cooled to 15° C. The resulting solids were filtered and washed with water several times to remove any inorganics to provide 51 (4.8 g, 89% yield).
  • 1) Preparation of Tri-TFP Ester 52
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00218
  • A slurry of triacid 51 (5.0 g, 10.7 mmol) and tetrafluorophenol (6.5 g, 38.8 mmol) in dichloromethane (50 mL) were cooled to 0° C. and treated with EDC hydrochloride (7.45 g, 38.8 mmol). The slurry was warmed to ambient and stirred for 18 hours. Upon reaction completion the reaction was washed with water and the organic layer was concentrated to an oil and purified on a silica column resulting in TFP ester 52 (1.63 g, 16% yield).
  • 2) Preparation of Tri-NAG Protected Alcohol 54
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00219
  • A solution of tri-TFP ester 52 (1.00 g, 1.10 mmol) and NAG-amine tosylate 53 (2.15 g, 3.33 mmol) in dichloromethane (5 mL) were cooled to 0° C. and treated with triethylamine (0.66 g, 6.6 mmol). The solution was allowed to warm to ambient over 2 hours. Upon completion, the reaction mixture was washed with water and concentrated to an oil. The crude oil was dissolved in acetic anhydride (30 mL) and the solution was treated with 1 mL triethylamine. After 3 hours, the organics were removed under high vacuum resulting in an oil 54 (1.7 g, 85% yield).
  • 3) Preparation of Phenol 55
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00220
  • The benzyl-protected alcohol 54 (2.0 g, 1.08 mmol) was dissolved in ethanol (23 mL) and placed under nitrogen atmosphere. To the solution was added 10%/Pd/C (0.7 g, 30 mol %). The slurry was stirred for 8 hours at ambient and the catalyst was removed via celite pad. The organics were removed under high vacuum resulting in a white solid 55 (1.4 g, 74% yield).
  • 4) Preparation of Compound 56
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00221
  • A solution of phenol 55 (1.3 g, 0.74 mmol) and phosphoramidite reagent (0.364 mg, 1.11 mmol) in dichloromethane (10 mL) were cooled to 0° C. and treated with 4,5-dicyanoimidazole and then allowed to warm to ambient over 2 hours. Upon completion, the reaction mixture was washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (10 mL), followed by water (10 mL) and the organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate. The organics were concentrated under reduced pressure resulting in a white solid (1.4 g, 93% yield).
  • Compound 56 of Example 7 is Structure 1026b herein.
  • Example 8. Physical Properties of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compounds
  • Certain GalNAc ligand phosphoramidite compounds that do not have the rigid linker structure disclosed herein have shown a propensity to gel in many common solvents. Attached at FIG. 7 is a photograph illustrating the behavior of a GalNAc structure having the same targeting moiety (N-acetyl-galactosamine), tether, and branch point group as Structure 1008b, but includes a PEG linker instead of the rigid linker of Structure 1008b disclosed herein. The PEG linker-GalNAc phosphoramidite compound was held for 12 hours in a 3:1 mixture of ACN:DMF at 0.1 M dilution over molecular sieves. The PEG linker-GalNAc shows significant gelling in this highly polar solvent system. For this PEG linker-GalNAc phosphoramidite compound, it is necessary to use up to 1:1 mixture of ACN:DMF to maintain solubility.
  • Attached at FIG. 8 is a photograph depicting phosphoramidite compound Structure 1008b being fully dissolved in 0.05 M in acetonitrile, without the need for a highly polar solvent such as DMF. Unlike PEG linker-GalNAc constructs, the phosphoramidite compounds that include the rigid linker of Structure 1008b are not at risk or require a highly polar solvent to maintain solubility. Despite being dissolved in the bottle at a lower concentration, this illustrates that the structures comprising the rigid linkers disclosed herein are more soluble in common solvents typically used for oligonucleotide synthesis, and do not require the addition of a highly polar solvent to prevent gelling.
  • Example 9. Purity of Targeting Ligand Phosphoramidite-Containing Compounds
  • As noted above in Example 2, FIG. 2A shows a 31P NMR spectra of the phosphoramidite compound of Structure 1008b. FIG. 2A shows a single peak exhibiting the correct shift for phosphoramidite. No other peaks, including hydrolysis peaks, are shown, which indicate a highly pure compound.
  • FIG. 9 shows a 31P NMR spectra of a PEG linker-GalNAc Structure, that otherwise includes the same branch point, tether, and targeting moiety as Structure 1008b. The chemical structure of the phosphoramidite for which the spectra of FIG. 9 was obtained is depicted on FIG. 9. FIG. 9 shows multiple impurity peaks, which include what appear to be hydrolyzed by-product.
  • Example 10. Oligonucleotide Composition Synthesis
  • A. Synthesis. RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis. Depending on the scale, either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation) was used. Syntheses were performed on a solid support made of controlled pore glass (CPG, 500 Å or 600 Å, obtained from Prime Synthesis, Aston, Pa., USA). All RNA and 2′-modified RNA phosphoramidites were purchased from Thermo Fisher Scientific (Milwaukee, Wis., USA). Specifically, the following 2′-O-methyl phosphoramidites were used: (5′-O-dimethoxytrityl-N6-(benzoyl)-2′-O-methyl-adenosine-3′-O-(2-cyanoethyl-N,N-diisopropy-lamino) phosphoramidite, 5′-O-dimethoxy-trityl-N4-(acetyl)-2′-O-methyl-cytidine-3′-O-(2-cyanoethyl-N,N-diisopropyl-amino) phosphoramidite, (5′-O-dimethoxytrityl-N2-(isobutyryl)-2′-O-methyl-guanosine-3′-O-(2-cyano-ethyl-N,N-diisopropylamino)phosphoramidite, and 5′-O-dimethoxy-trityl-2′-O-methyl-uridine-3′-O-(2-cyanoethyl-N,N-diisopropylamino)phosphoramidite. The 2′-deoxy-2′-fluoro-phosphoramidites carried the same protecting groups as the 2′-O-methyl RNA amidites. Targeting ligand containing phosphoramidites were dissolved in anhydrous dichloromethane or anhydrous acetonitrile (50 mM), while all other amidites were dissolved in anhydrous acetonitrile (50 mM) and molecular sieves (3 Å) were added. 5-Benzylthio-1H-tetrazole (BTT, 250 mM in acetonitrile) or 5-Ethylthio-1H-tetrazole (ETT, 250 mM in acetonitrile) was used as activator solution. Coupling times were 10 min (RNA), 15 min (targeting ligand), 90 sec (2′OMe), and 60 sec (2′F). In order to introduce phosphorothioate linkages, a 100 mM solution of 3-phenyl 1,2,4-dithiazoline-5-one (POS, obtained from PolyOrg, Inc., Leominster, Mass., USA) in anhydrous Acetonitrile was employed.
  • B. Cleavage and deprotection of support bound oligomer. After finalization of the solid phase synthesis, the dried solid support was treated with a 1:1 volume solution of 40 wt. % methylamine in water and 28% ammonium hydroxide solution (Aldrich) for two hours at 30° C. The solution was evaporated and the solid residue was reconstituted in water (see below).
  • C. Purification. Crude oligomers were purified by anionic exchange HPLC using a TKSgel SuperQ-5PW 13 u column and Shimadzu LC-8 system. Buffer A was 20 mM Tris, 5 mM EDTA, pH 9.0 and contained 20% Acetonitrile and buffer B was the same as buffer A with the addition of 1.5 M sodium chloride. UV traces at 260 nm were recorded. Appropriate fractions were pooled then run on size exclusion HPLC using a GE Healthcare XK 16/40 column packed with Sephadex G-25 medium with a running buffer of 100 mM ammonium bicarbonate, pH 6.7 and 20% Acetonitrile.
  • D. Annealing. Complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the RNAi agents. This solution was placed into a thermomixer at 70° C., heated to 95° C., held at 95° C. for 5 min, and cooled to room temperature slowly. Some RNAi agents were lyophilized and stored at −15 to −25° C. Duplex concentration was determined by measuring the solution absorbance on a UV-Vis spectrometer in 0.2×PBS. The solution absorbance at 260 nm was then multiplied by a conversion factor and the dilution factor to determine the duplex concentration. Unless otherwise stated, all conversion factor was 0.037 mg/(mL cm). For some experiments, a conversion factor was calculated from an experimentally determined extinction coefficient.
  • Example 11. Comparison of 3′ and 5′ Sense Strand Attachment Sites for GalNAc Targeting Ligands Using F12 Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds in Wild Type Mice
  • To assess differences in the site of attachment of GalNAc ligands between the 3′ and 5′ terminal end of the sense strand, expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) directed to F12 (referred to as F12 RNAi agents herein) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 1:
  • TABLE 1
    F12 expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 11.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD02803 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand Sequence: uAuAugscsccaagaAfaGfugaaagacca(NAG15) 1
    (AM03628-SS)
    Antisense Strand Sequence: usGfsgucuuUfcAfcuuUfcuugggcsuscuAu 2
    (AM03157-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD02807 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand Sequence: (NAG18)uauaugscsccaagaAfaGfugaaagacc(invdA) 3
    (AM03632-SS)
    Antisense Strand Sequence: usGfsgucuuUfcAfcuuUfcuugggcsuscuAu 4
    (AM03157-AS)
  • In Table 1, above, the following notations are used:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00222
  • Each strand of the F12 RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • The F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG15) or (NAG18)) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG15) or (NAG18)) were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 3 mg/kg (mpk) dose of one of two F12 RNAi agents (AD02803 or AD02807) in buffered saline. There were three (3) wild type mice per treatment group. As shown above, AD02803 includes (NAG15) attached to the 3′ terminal end of the sense strand, while AD 2807 includes (NAG18) attached to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days 8, 15, 22 and 29 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating mouse F12 protein (mF12) levels in serum by an internally developed mF12 alphaLISA® (Perkin Elmer). Expression at a specific bleed date was normalized to the mean of the saline control group for that same date.
  • FIG. 10 shows the results from this study. At nadir (day 22), AD02803 showed approximately 70% reduction in circulating F12 levels, while AD02807 showed a greater than 80% reduction. The data also show a difference in length of knockdown effect, as at day 29 AD02803-treated mice showed a faster return to baseline as compared to AD2807-treated mice. These data support that the linkage of a GalNAc ligand on the 5′ end of the sense strand outperforms linkage at the 3′ sense strand.
  • Example 12. Further Comparison of 3′ and 5′ Sense Strand Attachment Sites for GalNAc Targeting Ligands Using F12 Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds in Wild Type Mice
  • To further assess the site of attachment of GalNAc ligands on the 3′ and 5′ terminal ends of the sense strand of double-stranded expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents), compositions directed to the F12 gene were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 2:
  • TABLE 2
    F12 expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 12.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD02815 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand Sequence: (NAG20)uauaugscsccaagaAfaGfugaaagacc(invdA) 5
    (AM03640-SS)
    Antisense Strand Sequence: usGfsgucuuUfcAfcuuUfcuugggcsuscuAu 6
    (AM03157-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD02816 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand Sequence: uAuAugscsccaagaAfaGfugaaagacca(NAG20) 7
    (AM03641-SS)
    Antisense Strand Sequence: usGfsgucuuUfcAfcuuUfcuugggcsuscuAu 8
    (AM03157-AS)
  • In Table 2, above, the following notations are used:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00223
  • Each strand of the F12RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomiation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • The F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligand (i.e., (NAG20)) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligand (i.e., (NAG20)) were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 3 mg/kg (mpk) dose of one of the two RNAi agents (AD02815 or AD02816) in buffered saline. There were three (3) wild type mice per treatment group. As shown above in Table 2, AD02815 includes (NAG20) attached to the 5′ end of the sense strand, while AD02816 includes (NAG20) attached to the 3′ terminal end of the sense strand.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days 8, 15, 22 and 29 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating mouse F12 protein (mF12) levels in serum by an internally developed mF12 alphaLISA® (Perkin Elmer). Expression at a specific bleed date was normalized to the mean of the saline control group for that same date.
  • FIG. 11 shows the results from this experiment. At nadir (day 22), AD02816 showed approximately 60% reduction in circulating F12 protein levels, while AD02815 showed a 79% reduction. The data also show a difference in length of knockdown effect. At day 29, AD02816-treated mice show 40% knockdown while AD02815-treated mice show 71% knockdown from saline levels. These data support linkage of a GalNAc ligand at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand.
  • Example 13. Lp(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structure 1003 in Lp(a) Transgenic (Tg) Mice
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded Lp(a) RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 3:
  • TABLE 3
    LP(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 13.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03547 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG29)uauauaasuuaucgaGfGfcucauucucsa(invAb)  9
    Sequence: (AM04498-SS)
    Antisense Strand usGfsasGfaAfuGfaGfccuCfgAfuAfausuAUAUA 10
    Sequence: (AM04507-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03549 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG25)uauauaasuuaucgaGfGfcucauucucsa(invAb) 11
    Sequence: (AM04502-SS)
    Antisense Strand usGfsasGfaAfuGfaGfccuCfgAfuAfausuAUAUA 12
    Sequence: (AM04507-AS)
  • In Table 3, above, the following notations are used:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00224
  • (NAG29) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1003 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • Lp(a) transgenic (Tg) mice (Frazer K A et al 1995, Nature Genetics 9:424-431) were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo. This mouse expresses human apo(a) from a YAC containing the full LPA gene (encoding apo(a) protein) with additional sequences both 5′ and 3′, as well as the human apoB-100, thereby producing humanized Lp(a) particles (hereinafter referred to as “Lp(a) Tg mice.”) (Callow M J et al 1994, PNAS 91:2130-2134).
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25) or (NAG29)) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25) or (NAG29)) at the 5′ end of the sense strand were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the respective Lp(a) RNAi agent (AD03547 or AD03549) in buffered saline. There were four (4) Lp(a) Tg mice per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days −1 (pre-dose), 5, 11, 16, 22, 29, and 36. Knockdown was determined by calculating circulating Lp(a) particle levels in serum. Lp(a) particle levels were measured on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations. For normalization, Lp(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-dose level of expression in that animal (in this case at day −1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day −1.” Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day −1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day −1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 12. AD03549 (NAG25) showed 71% knockdown at nadir (day 16), and AD03547 (NAG29) showed 81% knockdown at nadir (day 11). Both triggers showed similar recovery curves after nadir, with less than 26% knockdown on day 36. These data support that the GalNAc ligands shown in Example 13 are comparable in both initial knockdown activity and duration of knockdown in Lp(a) Tg mice with a single 1 mg/kg dose.
  • Example 14. Apo(a) Knockdown in apo(a) Transgenic (Tg) Mice Following Administration of Lp(a) Expression-inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligand Structures 1002 and 1004
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded Lp(a) RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 4:
  • TABLE 4
    LP(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 14.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03536 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG25)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 13
    Sequence:
    (AM04496-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 14
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03538 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG28)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 15
    Sequence:
    (AM04499-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 16
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03540 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG30)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 17
    Sequence:
    (AM04500-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 18
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
  • In Table 4, above, the following notations are used:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00225
  • Additionally, (NAG25) has the same chemical structure as shown in Example 13, above.
  • (NAG28) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1002 herein. (NAG30) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1004 herein. (NAG28) includes a mixture of the cis- and trans-isomers, while (NAG30) is exclusively the trans-isomer.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • Apo(a) transgenic (Tg) mice were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo. Apo(a) Tg mice (Frazer K A et al 1995, Nature Genetics 9:424-431) express human apo(a) from a YAC containing the full LPA gene (encoding apo(a) protein) with additional sequences both 5′ and 3′ (hereinafter referred to as “apo(a) Tg mice”).
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25), (NAG28), or (NAG30)) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25), (NAG28), or (NAG30)) at the 5′ end of the sense strand were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 0.5 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the RNAi agent (AD03536, AD03538, or AD03540) in buffered saline. There were three (3) apo(a) Tg mice per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days −1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, and 29. Knockdown was determined by assaying serum from the mice using an ELISA for apo(a) (Abcam). For normalization, apo(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal (in this case at day −1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day −1”. Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day −1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day −1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard error of the mean.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 13. Nadir was day 15 for all RNAi agents tested. At nadir, AD03536 showed 74% knockdown of apo(a) protein, AD03538 showed 74% knockdown of apo(a) protein, and AD03540 showed 71% knockdown of apo(a) protein. At day 29, all of the RNAi agents show >48% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels except for AD03536 (containing NAG25) which shows only 16% knockdown. These data support that the NAG structures behave similarly with respect to initial knockdown activity, with the RNAi agents containing the linker structures NAG28 and NAG30 showing numerically greater knockdown at day 29.
  • Example 15. Lp(a) Knockdown in Lp(a) Tg Mice Following Administration of Lp(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structures 1005 and 1008
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded Lp(a) RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 5:
  • TABLE 5
    LP(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 15.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03536 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG25)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 19
    Sequence:
    (AM04496-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 20
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03629 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG31)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 21
    Sequence:
    (AM04611-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 22
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD04170 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG37)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 23
    Sequence:
    (AM05341-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 24
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
  • In Table 5, above, the following notations are used:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00226
  • Additionally, (NAG25) is the same structure as shown in Example 13, above.
  • (NAG31) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1005 herein. (NAG37) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1008 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • Lp(a) Tg mice were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25), (NAG31) or (NAG37)) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25), (NAG31), or (NAG37)) were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 3 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the RNAi agent (AD03536, AD03629, or AD04170) in buffered saline. There were four (4) Lp(a) Tg mice per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days −1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, 29, and 36. Knockdown was determined by calculating circulating Lp(a) particle levels in serum. Lp(a) particle levels were measured on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations. For normalization, Lp(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-dose level of expression in that animal (in this case at day −1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day −1.” Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day −1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day −1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Resulting data are shown in FIG. 14. AD03536 showed 95% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir (day 15), and maintained knockdown of 76% at day 36. AD03629 showed 97% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir (day 8), and maintained knockdown of 90% at day 36. AD04170 showed 97% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir (day 8), and maintained knockdown of 78% at day 36.
  • Example 16. F12 Knockdown in Wild Type Mice Following Administration of F12 Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structures 1005, 1008, 1025, and 1027
  • F12 expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded F12 RNAi agents) were prepared that were conjugated at the 5′ terminal end via a phosphorothioate linkage to GalNAc targeting ligands (NAG25)s [AD04162]; (NAG37)s [AD04623]; (NAG31)s [AD04512]; (NAG33)s [AD04650] or (NAG38)s [AD04651]. Each of the double-stranded RNAi agents were directed to F12.
  • The following notations are used for the GalNAc targeting ligand structures:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00227
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00228
  • (NAG31)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1005 herein. (NAG33)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1025 herein. (NAG37)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1008 herein. (NAG38)s has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1027 herein. The sequences and modification patterns were identical for AD04162, AD04623, AD04512, AD04650, and AD04651, with the only difference in the compositions being the GalNAc targeting ligand structure located at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of each F12 RNAi agent, as shown above.
  • Each strand of the F12 RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • The F12 RNAi agents conjugated to the respective GalNAc targeting ligands (i.e., (NAG25)s, (NAG31)s, (NAG33)s, (NAG37)s, or (NAG38)s) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The F12 RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., (NAG25)s, (NAG31)s, (NAG33)s, (NAG37)s, or (NAG38)s) were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 ul solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of one of five duplexes (AD04162, AD04623, AD04512, AD04650 and AD04651) in buffered saline. There were four (4) wild type mice per treatment group. As shown above, AD04162 includes the structure (NAG25)s, AD04623 includes the structure (NAG37)s, AD04512 includes the structure (NAG31)s, AD04650 includes the structure (NAG33)s, and AD04651 includes the structure (NAG38)s. All GalNAc targeting ligands were attached at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of each respective RNAi agent
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days −1 (pre-dose), 8, 15 and 22 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating mouse F12 protein (mF12) levels in serum by an internally developed mF12 alphaLISA® (Perkin Elmer). mF12 levels for each animal at a respective time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to pre-dose”. Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day pre-dose” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day pre-dose” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Results from this study are shown in FIG. 15. Nadir was day 8 for all RNAi agents tested. At nadir, AD04162 showed 90% knockdown of mF12, AD04623 showed 94% knockdown of mF12, AD04512 showed 94% knockdown of mF12, AD04650 showed 92% knockdown of mF12 and AD04651 showed 87% knockdown at of mF12. At day 22, all of the RNAi agents show >82% knockdown of mF12 levels except for AD04162 (containing NAG25) which shows only 74% knockdown. These data support that the NAG structures behave similarly with respect to initial knockdown activity, with the RNAi agents containing the rigid linker structures or linker replacement moieties disclosed herein (i.e., NAG31, NAG33, NAG37 and NAG38) showing numerically greater mF12 knockdown at day 22.
  • Example 17. Lp(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structures 1004 and 1005 in Lp(a) Tg Mice
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 6:
  • TABLE 6
    LP(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 17.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03629 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG31)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 25
    Sequence:
    (AM04611-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 26
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03540 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG30)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 27
    Sequence:
    (AM04500-SS)
    Antisense usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 28
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
  • In Table 6, (NAG30) is the same chemical structure as shown in Example 14, above, and (NAG31) is the same chemical structure as shown in Example 15, above.
  • NAG30 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1004 herein. NAG31 has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1005 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramiidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomiation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • Lp(a) Tg mice as described herein were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., NAG30 or NAG31) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., NAG30 or NAG31) at the 5′ end of the sense strand were delivered via SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the Lp(a) RNAi agent (AD03629 or AD03540) in buffered saline. There were four (4) Lp(a) Tg mice per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days −1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, 29, 36 and 43. Knockdown was determined by calculating circulating Lp(a) particle levels in serum. Lp(a) particle levels were measured on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations. For normalization, Lp(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-dose level of expression in that animal (in this case at day −1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day −1.” Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day −1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day −1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 16. Nadir was day 15 for both RNAi agents studied. AD03629 showed 89% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir, while AD03540 showed 85% knockdown of Lp(a) levels at nadir. Both RNAi agents showed similar recovery curves to day 36. However, at day 43, while AD03540 showed 16% knockdown of Lp(a) levels, AD03629 showed 55% knockdown of Lp(a) levels.
  • Example 18. Apo(a) Knockdown in apo(a) Tg Mice Following Administration of Lp(a) Expression-inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds Linked to Targeting Ligand Structures 1007, 1025, and 1026
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 7:
  • TABLE 7
    LP(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 18.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID AD03721: 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG33)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 29
    Sequence:
    (AM04742-SS)
    Antisense Strand usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 30
    Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID:AD03722 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG34)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 31
    Sequence:
    (AM04743-SS)
    Antisense Strand usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 32
    Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03723 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense Strand (NAG35)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 33
    Sequence:
    (AM04744-SS)
    Antisense Strand usCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 34
    Sequence:
    (AM03972-AS)
  • In Table 7, above, the following notations are used:
  • Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00229
    Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00230
  • (NAG33) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1025 herein. (NAG34) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1026 herein. (NAG35) has the chemical structure represented by Structure 1007 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • Apo(a) transgenic (Tg) mice were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to the respective GalNAc ligands (i.e., NAG33, NAG34 or NAG35) were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • Lp(a) RNAi agents conjugated to the respective GalNAc targeting ligands (i.e., NAG33, NAG34 or NAG35) were administered by SC injection. On day 1, a SC injection was administered into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing either saline or a 1 mg/kg (mpk) dose of the RNAi agent (AD03721, AD03722, or AD03723) in buffered saline. There were three (3) apo(a) Tg mice per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated mice were taken on days −1 (pre-dose), 8, 15, 22, and 29. Knockdown was determined by assaying circulating apo(a) protein levels in serum. Human apo(a) protein levels in serum were monitored by assaying serum from the mice using an ELISA for apo(a) (Abcam). For normalization, apo(a) level for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal (in this case at day −1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day −1”. Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day −1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day −1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. Experimental error is given as standard error of the mean.
  • Resulting data are shown in FIG. 17. Nadir was day 15 for all RNAi agents studied. AD03721 showed 91% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels at nadir, AD03722 showed 81% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels at nadir, while AD03723 showed 90% knockdown of apo(a) protein levels at nadir. Recovery of apo(a) protein levels after treatment showed similar trajectories, with both AD03721 and AD03723-treated mice showing nearly identical knockdown at each timepoint, whereas AD03722-treated mice showed numerically less knockdown at each timepoint tested. For example, at Day 29, AD03721-treated mice showed 76% knockdown of apo(a) levels, AD03723-treated mice showed 83% knockdown of apo(a) levels, while AD03722-treated mice showed 61% knockdown of apo(a) levels. These data support that the NAG33, NAG34 and NAG35 structures all show knockdown activity, with the RNAi agents containing structures NAG33 and NAG35 showing numerically greater a knockdown at day 29.
  • Example 19. Dose Response of LP(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structure 1008, Dosed at 1 mg/kg and 3 Mg/Kg in Lp(a) Tg Mice
  • Lp(a) transgenic mice as described herein were used to evaluate the efficacy of double-stranded RNAi agents with conjugated N-acetyl-galactosamine ligands in vivo. RNAi agents directed to Lp(a) having Duplex ID: AD04170, as set forth above in Example 15, were manufactured. As set forth above, Lp(a) Duplex ID: AD04170 includes a (NAG37) targeting ligand (Structure 1008) attached at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to targeting ligand Structure 1008 were combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to targeting ligand Structure 1008 were administered by subcutaneous (SC) injection. On day 1, a SC injection was made into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse containing a dose of either saline, 1 mg/kg (mpk) of the RNAi agent in buffered saline, or 3 mg/kg (mpk) of the RNAi agent in buffered saline.
  • Control serum (pre-treatment) samples were taken from the mice pre-injection on day −1. Lp(a) particle levels were determined on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations. For normalization, Lp(a) levels for each animal at a time point was divided by the pre-treatment level of expression in that animal (in this case at day −1) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to day −1.” Expression at a specific time point was then normalized to the saline control group by dividing the “normalized to day −1” ratio for an individual animal by the mean “normalized to day −1” ratio of all mice in the saline control group. This resulted in expression for each time point normalized to that in the control group. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • Results are shown in FIG. 18. As shown in FIG. 18, a dose-dependent relationship is apparent for the Lp(a) RNAi agent across all time points.
  • Example 20: LP(a) Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structures 1003 and 1004 in Cynomolgus Monkeys
  • Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double-stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 8:
  • TABLE 8
    Lp(a) expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 20.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD03668 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense (NAG30)(invAb)GfcCfcCfuUfAfUfuGfuUfaUfaCfgausu(invAb) 35
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM04500-SS)
    Antisense cPrpTMsCfsgsUfaUfaAfCfAfauaAfgGfgGfcusu 36
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM04501-AS)
  • Lp(a) RNAi agent AD03547 is the same as shown in Example 13, and is conjugated to (NAG29). Lp(a) RNAi agent AD3668 was conjugated to (NAG30). (NAG30) has the chemical structure shown in Example 14. (NAG29) is represented by Structure 1003 herein. (NAG30) is represented by Structure 1004 herein.
  • Each strand of the Lp(a) RNAi agents was synthesized according to phosphoramidite technology on solid phase used in oligonucleotide synthesis using either a MerMade96E® (Bioautomation) or a MerMade12® (Bioautomation), and complementary strands were mixed by combining equimolar RNA solutions (sense and antisense) in 0.2×PBS (Phosphate-Buffered Saline, 1×, Corning, Cellgro) to form the duplexes, following the methods generally described in Example 10 herein.
  • The Lp(a) RNAi agents conjugated to targeting ligands disclosed herein having Structure 1003 or Structure 1004, were made and combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SQ) injection.
  • Control serum (pre-treatment) samples were taken from the cynomolgus monkeys pre-injection on day −14, −7, and day 1 (pre-dose). Lp(a) particle levels were determined on a Cobas® Integra 400 (Roche Diagnostics) according to the manufacturer's recommendations. For normalization, Lp(a) levels for each animal at a time point was divided by the average of the pre-treatment levels of expression in that animal (in this case at days −14, −7, and day 1 (pre-dose)) to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to pre-dose.” Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • On day 1, cynomolgus macaque (Macaca fascicularis) primates were injected subcutaneously with Lp(a) RNAi agents linked to targeting ligands disclosed herein with 3 mg/kg of either Lp(a) RNAi agent AD03668 or Lp(a) RNAi agent AD03547. Two (2) monkeys were dosed per treatment group.
  • Results are reported in FIG. 19. Lp(a) RNAi triggers conjugated to either Structure 1003 (AD03547) or Structure 1004 (AD03668) showed knockdown in cynomolgus monkeys.
  • Example 21: F12 Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structure 1008 in Cynomolgus Monkeys
  • F12 RNAi agents having varying sequences directed to F12 and linked to GalNAc targeting ligand Structure 1008 [(NAG37)s] at the 5′ end of the sense strand, were made and combined in a pharmaceutically acceptable buffer as known in the art for subcutaneous (SC) injection. (NAG37)s has the chemical structure as shown in Example 16, above.
  • On day 1, cynomolgus macaque (Macaca fascicularis) primates were injected subcutaneously with 3 mg/kg of one of six (6) different Lp(a) RNAi agents having different sequence structures and different modification patterns: AD04623, AD04624, AD04625, AD04626, AD04627, or AD04628. Two (2) monkeys were dosed per treatment group.
  • Serum samples from treated cynomolgus monkeys were taken on day −7 and day 1 (pre-dose), and on days 8, 15 and 22 to monitor knockdown. Knockdown was measured by quantifying circulating cyno F12 protein (cF12) levels in serum by a human F12 ELISA kit (Molecular Innovations). cF12 levels for each animal at a respective time point was divided by the pre-treatment level (average of day −7 and day 1) of expression in that animal to determine the ratio of expression “normalized to pre-dose”. Experimental error is given as standard deviation.
  • FIG. 20 shows the results. Each of the F12 RNAi agents linked to NAG37 (Structure 1008) showed knockdown in cynomolgus monkeys, with AD04625 and AD04623 showing the greatest knockdown across all time points measured.
  • Example 22. Alpha-1 Antiypsin Expression-Inhibiting Oligomeric Compounds (Double-Stranded RNAi Agents) Linked to Targeting Ligands of Structure 1008 in PiZ Transgenic Mice
  • To evaluate RNAi agents directed to the alpha-1 antitrypsin (AAT) gene in vivo, a transgenic PiZ mouse model (PiZ mice) was used. PiZ mice harbor the human PiZ AAT mutant allele and model human AATD (Carlson et al., Journal of Clinical Investigation 1989). AAT expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (double stranded RNAi agents) were prepared having the sequences set forth in the following Table 9:
  • TABLE 9
    AAT expression-inhibiting oligomeric compounds (RNAi agent duplexes) of
    Example 22.
    SEQ
    Duplex ID: AD04663 5′→3′ ID NO:
    Sense (NAG37)s(invAb)sucaacaAfAfCfccuuugucuus(invAb) 37
    Strand Sequence:
    (AM05968-SS)
    Antisense Strand asAfsgsAfcAfaAfgGfgUfuUfgUfuGfausu 38
    Sequence:
    (AM05969-AS)
  • (NAG37)s has the chemical structure as shown in Example 16, above.
  • The AAT RNAi agent was prepared in a pharmaceutically acceptable saline buffer and administered by subcutaneous (SC) injection into the loose skin on the back between the shoulders of 200 μl solution/20 g mouse to PiZ mice to evaluate knockdown of AAT gene expression. Each mouse received a single SC dose of 3 mg/kg (mpk) of AD04463. Three mice were dosed with the AAT RNAi agent (n=3).
  • Plasma samples were drawn and analyzed for AAT (Z-AAT) protein levels on days −1, day 1 (pre-dose), day 8, and day 15. AAT levels were normalized to day 1 (pre-dose) AAT plasma levels. Protein levels were measured by quantifying circulating human Z-AAT levels in plasma by an ELISA kit.
  • The average normalized AAT (Z-AAT) levels are shown in FIG. 21. The AAT RNAi agent linked to the targeting ligand of Structure 1008 herein showed knockdown in PiZ transgenic mice.
  • OTHER EMBODIMENTS
  • It is to be understood that while the invention has been described in conjunction with the detailed description thereof, the foregoing description is intended to illustrate and not limit the scope of the invention, which is defined by the scope of the appended claims. Other aspects, advantages, and modifications are within the scope of the following claims.

Claims (47)

1. A targeting ligand comprising a structure of Formula I:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00231
comprising a linker, a branch point group, one or more tethers, and one or more targeting moieties, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 4, and wherein the linker is a structure selected from the group consisting of:
(Structure 2);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00232
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00233
wherein n′ is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10, and when present, each Z′ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure 7);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00234
wherein n″ is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, and when present, each Z″ is independently selected from the group consisting of: C1-C6 alkyl, C2-C6 alkenyl, C2-C6 alkynyl, C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 aminoalkyl, substituted C2-C6 alkenyl, substituted C2-C6 alkynyl, substituted or unsubstituted amino, carboxyl, substituted C1-C6 alkoxy, substituted C1-C6 aminoalkyl, halogen (e.g., F), hydroxyl, amido, substituted amide, cyano, substituted or unsubstituted keto, substituted or unsubstituted alkoxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryloxycarbonyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryloxycarbonyl, and sulfhydryl (Structure 8); and
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00235
wherein V comprises one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), or substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.), or any covalently linked combination thereof. (Structure 9).
2. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the linker is a structure selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00236
3. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the linker is:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00237
4. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the branch point group is a structure selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00238
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00239
wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (Structure 209);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00240
wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20, and n is an integer from 0 to 20 (Structure 210);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00241
wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20; n is an integer from 0 to 20; x is an integer from to 1 to 10; y is an integer from 1 to 10; z is an integer from 1 to 4; and K is selected from the group consisting of substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), and substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc. or an combination thereof structure 211);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00242
wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20; n is an integer from 0 to 20; x is an integer from to 1 to 10; and y is an integer from 1 to 10 (Structure 212);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00243
wherein m is an integer from 0 to 20; n is an integer from 0 to 20; x is an integer from to 1 to 10; y is an integer from 1 to 10; G is selected from the group c;
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00244
or any substituted or unsubstituted cyclic or heterocyclic structure having a ring size of 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 atoms, for example, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl (Structure 213);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00245
wherein n is an integer from 0 to 20 (Structure 214);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00246
wherein n is an integer from 0 to 20, and Q is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00247
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00248
wherein n is an integer selected from 1 to 7 (Structure 219).
5. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the branch point group is:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00249
6. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the tether is independently selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00250
wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH (Structure 301);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00251
wherein X is O, S, or NH (Structure 302);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00252
(Structure 302a);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00253
wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH (Structure 303);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00254
wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 or 20), and X is O, S, or NH (Structure 304);
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00255
wherein X is O, S, or NH (Structure 305); and
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00256
wherein X is O, S, or NH (Structure 306).
7. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the targeting moiety is independently selected from the group consisting of: N-acetyl-galactosamine, galactose, galactosamine, N-formyl-galactosamine, N-propionyl-galactosamine, N-n-butanoylgalactosamine, and N-iso-butanoylgalactosamine.
8. The targeting ligand of claim 7, wherein the targeting moiety is N-acetyl-galactosamine.
9. The targeting ligand of claim 7, wherein the targeting moiety is independently selected from glycans, haptens, vitamins, folate, biotin, aptamers, and peptides, such as RGD-containing peptides, insulin, EGF, and transferrin.
10. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein n is 3.
11. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein n is 4.
12. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the targeting ligand is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
13. The targeting ligand of claim 12, wherein the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent.
14. The targeting ligand of claim 13, wherein the RNAi agent is double-stranded.
15. The targeting ligand of claim 14, wherein the RNAi agent includes one or more modified nucleotides.
16. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the targeting ligand comprises the structure selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00257
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00258
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00259
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00260
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00261
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00262
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00263
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00264
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00265
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00266
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00267
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00268
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00269
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00270
17. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the structure is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00271
18. The targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the targeting ligand is linked to an RNAi agent.
19. The targeting ligand of claim 18, wherein the RNAi agent is double-stranded.
20. The targeting ligand of claim 19, wherein the double-stranded RNAi agent is linked to the targeting ligand at the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of an RNAi agent.
21. The targeting ligand of claim 18, wherein the RNAi agent is linked to the linker of the targeting ligand via a phosphate group, phosphorothioate group, or a phosphonate group.
22. A composition comprising a targeting ligand of claim 1, wherein the targeting ligand is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound, wherein the structure of the targeting ligand and expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is represented by the structure selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00272
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00273
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00274
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00275
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00276
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00277
wherein R in each structure comprises an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
23. The composition of claim 22, wherein the targeting ligand is linked to the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound via a phosphate group, phosphorothioate group, or a phosphonate group.
24. The composition of claim 22, wherein the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent.
25. The composition of claim 24, wherein the RNAi agent is a double-stranded RNAi agent.
26. The composition of claim 25, wherein the targeting ligand is linked to the 5′ terminal end of the sense strand of an RNAi agent.
27. A compound having the structure selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00278
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00279
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00280
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00281
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00282
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00283
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00284
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00285
28. A targeting ligand comprising a structure of Formula II:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00286
comprising a branch point group with linker replacement moiety, one or more tethers, and one or more targeting moieties, wherein n is an integer between 1 and 4, and wherein the linker replacement moiety includes one or more substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl (e.g., cyclohexyl, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cycloheptyl, cycloocty, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkenyl (e.g., cyclohexenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cycloheptenyl, cyclooctenyl, cyclohexadienyl, cyclopentadienyl, cycloheptadienyl, cyclooctadienyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted aryl (e.g., phenyl, naphthyl, binapthyl, anthracenyl, etc.), substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl (e.g., pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrrole, imidazole, furan, benzofuran, indole, etc.), or substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclyl (e.g., tetrahydrofuran, tetrahydropyran, piperidine, pyrrolidine, etc.), or any combination thereof, is located within the branch point group.
29. The targeting ligand of claim 28, wherein the branch point group with linker replacement moiety is selected from:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00287
30. The targeting ligand of claim 29, comprising the structure selected from:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00288
31. The targeting ligand of claim 28, wherein the targeting ligand is linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
32. The targeting ligand of claim 31, wherein the targeting ligand linked to an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound has the following structure:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00289
wherein R comprises the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound (Structure 1027a).
33. The targeting ligand of claim 28, wherein the expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound is an RNAi agent.
34. The targeting ligand of claim 33, wherein the RNAi agent is double stranded.
35. The targeting ligand of claim 34, wherein the RNAi agent includes one or more modified nucleotides.
36. A method of inhibiting expression of a target nucleic acid in a subject, the method comprising administering to the subject a therapeutic amount of an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound linked to any of the targeting ligands of claim 1.
37. A method of introducing a therapeutic agent into a mammalian cell, the method comprising contacting a mammalian cell with the targeting ligand of claim 1, linked to the therapeutic agent.
38. The method of claim 37, wherein the cell is present in a subject.
39. The method of claim 38, wherein the subject is a human.
40. The method of claim 37, wherein the therapeutic agent is an expression-inhibiting oligomeric compound.
41. The method of claim 40, wherein the therapeutic agent is a double-stranded RNAi agent.
42. A method of treating a disease or disorder that would benefit from administration of a therapeutic compound, the method comprising administering a therapeutic amount of the targeting ligand of on claim 1 linked to a therapeutic compound to a subject in need of treatment thereof.
43. A method of treating a disease or disorder that would benefit from administration of a therapeutic compound, the method comprising administering a therapeutic amount of the composition of claim 22 to a subject in need of treatment thereof.
44. A method of manufacturing a phosphoramidite compound including a targeting ligand of claim 1, the method comprising:
(i) covalently linking the carboxylic acid moiety (or its activated ester) of the linker to a terminal amine located on the branch point group, and
(ii) linking the linker to a phosphorus atom of a phosphoramidite through a phosphitylation reaction with a phosphoramidite forming reagent; thereby forming a phosphoramidite compound that includes a targeting ligand.
45. The method of claim 44, wherein the phosphoramidite reagent is selected from:
Figure US20220033817A1-20220203-C00290
46. A targeting ligand of claim 1, linked to a therapeutic agent, for use as a medicament.
47. A targeting ligand of claim 1, linked to a therapeutic agent, for use in introducing a therapeutic agent into a mammalian cell, for inhibiting expression of a target nucleic acid in a subject, or for treating a disease or disorder that would benefit from administration of a therapeutic agent.
US17/351,169 2016-09-02 2021-06-17 Targeting Ligands Pending US20220033817A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US17/351,169 US20220033817A1 (en) 2016-09-02 2021-06-17 Targeting Ligands

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201662383221P 2016-09-02 2016-09-02
US201762456339P 2017-02-08 2017-02-08
US15/452,324 US10294474B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2017-03-07 Targeting ligands
US16/380,695 US11174481B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2019-04-10 Targeting ligands
US17/351,169 US20220033817A1 (en) 2016-09-02 2021-06-17 Targeting Ligands

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/380,695 Continuation US11174481B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2019-04-10 Targeting ligands

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20220033817A1 true US20220033817A1 (en) 2022-02-03

Family

ID=61281611

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/452,324 Active US10294474B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2017-03-07 Targeting ligands
US16/380,695 Active US11174481B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2019-04-10 Targeting ligands
US17/351,169 Pending US20220033817A1 (en) 2016-09-02 2021-06-17 Targeting Ligands

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/452,324 Active US10294474B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2017-03-07 Targeting ligands
US16/380,695 Active US11174481B2 (en) 2016-09-02 2019-04-10 Targeting ligands

Country Status (15)

Country Link
US (3) US10294474B2 (en)
EP (1) EP3506913A4 (en)
JP (2) JP6989521B2 (en)
KR (3) KR102403408B1 (en)
CN (3) CN116942841A (en)
AU (2) AU2017320582B2 (en)
BR (1) BR112019004178A2 (en)
CA (1) CA3011668A1 (en)
IL (2) IL300869A (en)
JO (2) JOP20170056B1 (en)
MX (3) MX2018009853A (en)
SG (2) SG11201901841TA (en)
TW (2) TW202320855A (en)
UY (1) UY37145A (en)
WO (1) WO2018044350A1 (en)

Cited By (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11534453B2 (en) 2015-08-07 2022-12-27 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi therapy for hepatitis B virus infection
US11590156B2 (en) 2016-08-04 2023-02-28 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents for hepatitis B virus infection

Families Citing this family (34)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
SG194751A1 (en) 2011-06-30 2013-12-30 Arrowhead Res Corp Compositions and methods for inhibiting gene expression of hepatitis b virus
US10294474B2 (en) * 2016-09-02 2019-05-21 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting ligands
BR112019014282A2 (en) 2017-01-10 2020-03-03 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. ANTITHRIPSIN RNAI AGENTS (AAT) ALPHA-1, COMPOSITIONS INCLUDING AAT RNAI AGENTS, AND METHODS OF USE
CN111107853A (en) * 2017-09-11 2020-05-05 箭头药业股份有限公司 RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of apolipoprotein C-III (APOC3)
JP7281452B2 (en) 2017-09-14 2023-05-25 アローヘッド ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッド RNAi Agents and Compositions for Inhibiting Expression of Angiopoietin-Like 3 (ANGPTL3) and Methods of Use
CA3079413A1 (en) 2017-10-17 2019-04-25 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Rnai agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of asialoglycoprotein receptor 1
EP3719128A4 (en) 2017-12-01 2021-10-27 Suzhou Ribo Life Science Co., Ltd. Double-stranded oligonucleotide, composition and conjugate comprising double-stranded oligonucleotide, preparation method therefor and use thereof
WO2019105419A1 (en) 2017-12-01 2019-06-06 苏州瑞博生物技术有限公司 Nucleic acid, composition and conjugate containing same, preparation method, and use
CN116375774A (en) 2017-12-29 2023-07-04 苏州瑞博生物技术股份有限公司 Conjugate, preparation method and application thereof
WO2020038377A1 (en) 2018-08-21 2020-02-27 苏州瑞博生物技术有限公司 Nucleic acid, pharmaceutical composition and conjugate containing nucleic acid, and use thereof
US11896674B2 (en) 2018-09-30 2024-02-13 Suzhou Ribo Life Science Co., Ltd. SiRNA conjugate, preparation method therefor and use thereof
WO2020147847A1 (en) * 2019-01-18 2020-07-23 苏州瑞博生物技术有限公司 Nucleic acid, composition and conjugate containing nucleic acid, preparation method, and use
CN114206389A (en) * 2019-03-21 2022-03-18 有丝分裂疗法有限责任公司 Multivalent ligand clusters for targeted delivery of therapeutic agents
JP2022536945A (en) 2019-06-18 2022-08-22 ヤンセン・サイエンシズ・アイルランド・アンリミテッド・カンパニー Combination of hepatitis B virus (HBV) vaccine and RNAi targeting HBV
AU2020340987A1 (en) * 2019-09-03 2022-04-14 Arcturus Therapeutics, Inc. Asialoglycoprotein receptor mediated delivery of therapeutically active conjugates
MX2022011012A (en) 2020-03-06 2022-10-07 Aligos Therapeutics Inc Modified short interfering nucleic acid (sina) molecules and uses thereof.
AU2021242321A1 (en) * 2020-03-26 2022-10-06 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents for inhibiting expression of PNPLA3, pharmaceutical compositions thereof, and methods of use
WO2021198958A1 (en) 2020-04-01 2021-10-07 Janssen Biopharma, Inc. Nucleic acid polymers
CA3179931A1 (en) 2020-04-10 2021-10-14 Aligos Therapeutics, Inc. Short interfering nucleic acid (sina) molecules and uses thereof for coronavirus diseases
WO2021254360A1 (en) * 2020-06-16 2021-12-23 上海拓界生物医药科技有限公司 Carbohydrate molecular cluster and preparation method therefor and medical use thereof
BR112023004756A2 (en) 2020-09-15 2024-02-06 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals Inc METHODS FOR REDUCING Z-AAT PROTEIN LEVELS
IL302330A (en) * 2020-11-05 2023-06-01 Amgen Inc METHODS FOR TREATING ATHEROSCLEROTIC CARDIOVASCULAR DISEASE WITH LPA-TARGETED RNAi CONSTRUCTS
WO2022189861A1 (en) 2021-03-08 2022-09-15 Tollys Carbohydrate conjugates of tlr3 ligands and uses thereof
AU2022262794A1 (en) 2021-04-23 2023-11-02 Beth Israel Deaconess Medical Center, Inc. Glycan modified nucleic acids, methods of preparation, and therapeutic uses
CN117836307A (en) 2021-06-18 2024-04-05 弘景生物科技有限公司 Functionalized N-acetylgalactosamine nucleosides
US11549112B1 (en) 2021-06-21 2023-01-10 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents for inhibiting expression of xanthine dehydrogenase (XDH), pharmaceutical compositions thereof, and methods of use
WO2023002452A1 (en) * 2021-07-23 2023-01-26 Janssen Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Process for preparation of targeting ligands
WO2023034719A1 (en) 2021-08-30 2023-03-09 Hongene Biotech Corporation Functionalized n-acetylgalactosamine analogs
WO2023039076A1 (en) 2021-09-08 2023-03-16 Aligos Therapeutics, Inc. Modified short interfering nucleic acid (sina) molecules and uses thereof
WO2023039005A2 (en) 2021-09-08 2023-03-16 Aligos Therapeutics, Inc. Modified short interfering nucleic acid (sina) molecules and uses thereof
WO2023138664A1 (en) * 2022-01-20 2023-07-27 上海金中锘美生物医药科技有限公司 Targeting ligand and use thereof
TW202400787A (en) 2022-03-16 2024-01-01 美商安彼瑞可股份有限公司 Galnac compositions for improving sirna bioavailability
WO2023196941A1 (en) 2022-04-08 2023-10-12 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Treatment of a non-alcoholic fatty liver disease
WO2023233290A1 (en) 2022-05-31 2023-12-07 Janssen Sciences Ireland Unlimited Company Rnai agents targeting pd-l1

Citations (13)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9127276B2 (en) * 2013-05-01 2015-09-08 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Conjugated antisense compounds and their use
US10240153B2 (en) * 2014-07-16 2019-03-26 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Organic compositions to treat APOC3-related diseases
US10246709B2 (en) * 2016-03-07 2019-04-02 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting ligands for therapeutic compounds
US10294474B2 (en) * 2016-09-02 2019-05-21 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting ligands
US10450565B2 (en) * 2017-01-10 2019-10-22 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Alpha-1 antitrypsin (AAT) RNAi agents, compositions including AAT RNAi agents, and methods of use
US10597657B2 (en) * 2017-09-11 2020-03-24 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of apolipoprotein C-III (APOC3)
US10662427B2 (en) * 2015-10-01 2020-05-26 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting gene expression of LPA
US10995335B2 (en) * 2017-09-14 2021-05-04 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of angiopoietin-like 3 (ANGPTL3), and methods of use
US20210301294A1 (en) * 2020-03-26 2021-09-30 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi Agents For Inhibiting Expression Of PNPLA3, Pharmaceutical Compositions Thereof, And Methods Of Use
US20220056454A1 (en) * 2018-09-19 2022-02-24 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi Agents for Inhibiting Expression of 17beta-HSD Type 13 (HSD17B13), Compositions Thereof, and Methods of Use
US20220152079A1 (en) * 2019-08-05 2022-05-19 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods For The Treatment Of APOC3-Related Diseases And Disorders
US11492624B2 (en) * 2017-10-17 2022-11-08 Arrowheads Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of Asialoglycoprotein receptor 1
US20220402947A1 (en) * 2018-02-17 2022-12-22 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Trialkyne Linking Agents and Methods of Use

Family Cites Families (90)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4469863A (en) 1980-11-12 1984-09-04 Ts O Paul O P Nonionic nucleic acid alkyl and aryl phosphonates and processes for manufacture and use thereof
US4751219A (en) 1985-02-05 1988-06-14 Nederlandse Centrale Organisatie Voor Toegepast-Natuur-Wetenschappelijk Onderzoek Synthetic glycolipides, a process for the preparation thereof and several uses for these synthetic glycolipides
NL9201440A (en) * 1992-08-11 1994-03-01 Univ Leiden Triantennary cluster glycosides, their preparation and application.
US6908903B1 (en) 1994-12-07 2005-06-21 Aletheon Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Cluster clearing agents
US6172045B1 (en) 1994-12-07 2001-01-09 Neorx Corporation Cluster clearing agents
WO1997020563A1 (en) 1995-11-22 1997-06-12 The Johns-Hopkins University Ligands to enhance cellular uptake of biomolecules
US20030119724A1 (en) 1995-11-22 2003-06-26 Ts`O Paul O.P. Ligands to enhance cellular uptake of biomolecules
US5998203A (en) 1996-04-16 1999-12-07 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Enzymatic nucleic acids containing 5'-and/or 3'-cap structures
US6620916B1 (en) 1996-09-26 2003-09-16 Ajinomoto Co., Inc. Modified physiologically active proteins and medicinal compositions containing the same
US6300319B1 (en) 1998-06-16 2001-10-09 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeted oligonucleotide conjugates
EA003790B1 (en) 1998-10-30 2003-10-30 Дайити Фармасьютикал Ко., Лтд. Ddc compounds and methods for assaying the same
US6383812B1 (en) 1999-05-28 2002-05-07 Academia Sinica Anti liver disease drug R-YEEE and method of synthesizing branched galactose-terminal glycoproteins
US20080281041A1 (en) 1999-06-07 2008-11-13 Rozema David B Reversibly Masked Polymers
US8541548B2 (en) 1999-06-07 2013-09-24 Arrowhead Madison Inc. Compounds and methods for reversible modification of biologically active molecules
US7833992B2 (en) 2001-05-18 2010-11-16 Merck Sharpe & Dohme Conjugates and compositions for cellular delivery
US7491805B2 (en) 2001-05-18 2009-02-17 Sirna Therapeutics, Inc. Conjugates and compositions for cellular delivery
WO2001075164A2 (en) 2000-03-30 2001-10-11 Whitehead Institute For Biomedical Research Rna sequence-specific mediators of rna interference
AU2002217980A1 (en) 2000-12-01 2002-06-11 Cell Works Inc. Conjugates of glycosylated/galactosylated peptide
TR200401292T3 (en) 2000-12-01 2004-07-21 Max@Planck@Gesellschaft�Zur�F�Rderung�Der�Wissenschaften the rnaágirişimineáyoláaçanáküçükárnaámolekül
EP1386004A4 (en) 2001-04-05 2005-02-16 Ribozyme Pharm Inc Modulation of gene expression associated with inflammation proliferation and neurite outgrowth, using nucleic acid based technologies
US7875612B2 (en) 2001-04-24 2011-01-25 Purdue Research Foundation Folate mimetics and folate-receptor binding conjugates thereof
EP2415486B1 (en) 2001-05-18 2017-02-22 Sirna Therapeutics, Inc. Conjugates and compositions for cellular delivery
US7109165B2 (en) 2001-05-18 2006-09-19 Sirna Therapeutics, Inc. Conjugates and compositions for cellular delivery
WO2003008628A2 (en) 2001-07-20 2003-01-30 Ribozyme Pharmacuticals, Inc. Enzymatic nucleic acid peptide conjugates
US7439043B2 (en) 2001-10-10 2008-10-21 Neose Technologies, Inc. Galactosyl nucleotide sugars
US20100240730A1 (en) 2002-02-20 2010-09-23 Merck Sharp And Dohme Corp. RNA Interference Mediated Inhibition of Gene Expression Using Chemically Modified Short Interfering Nucleic Acid (siNA)
WO2004024757A2 (en) 2002-09-11 2004-03-25 Santaris Pharma A/S Modified pna molecules
EP1605978B1 (en) 2003-03-07 2010-09-01 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals Inc. Therapeutic compositions
JP2006522158A (en) 2003-04-03 2006-09-28 アルナイラム ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッド iRNA complex
EP2669377A3 (en) 2003-04-17 2015-10-14 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals Inc. Modified iRNA agents
US7723509B2 (en) 2003-04-17 2010-05-25 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals IRNA agents with biocleavable tethers
US7851615B2 (en) 2003-04-17 2010-12-14 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Lipophilic conjugated iRNA agents
JPWO2004101619A1 (en) 2003-05-15 2006-10-26 塩野義製薬株式会社 Rational design and synthesis of functional glycopeptides
EP1661879A4 (en) * 2003-08-04 2006-11-29 Ono Pharmaceutical Co Diphenyl ether compound, process for producing the same, and use
EP1791567B1 (en) 2004-08-10 2015-07-29 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals Inc. Chemically modified oligonucleotides
WO2006031461A2 (en) 2004-09-09 2006-03-23 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Pyrrolidinyl groups for attaching conjugates to oligomeric compounds
US20060148740A1 (en) 2005-01-05 2006-07-06 Prosensa B.V. Mannose-6-phosphate receptor mediated gene transfer into muscle cells
US20080206869A1 (en) 2005-01-24 2008-08-28 Avaris Ab Nucleic Acid Complex
RU2416601C2 (en) * 2005-02-25 2011-04-20 Оно Фармасьютикал Ко., Лтд. Indole compound and use thereof
US8658211B2 (en) 2006-08-18 2014-02-25 Arrowhead Madison Inc. Polyconjugates for in vivo delivery of polynucleotides
CN102614528B (en) 2006-08-18 2014-02-26 箭头研究公司 Polyconjugates for in vivo delivery of polynucleotides
EP2606911A1 (en) 2007-02-16 2013-06-26 KTB Tumorforschungsgesellschaft mbH Receptor And Antigen Targeted Prodrug
AU2008242583B2 (en) 2007-04-23 2013-10-10 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Glycoconjugates of RNA interference agents
AU2008333811B2 (en) 2007-12-04 2014-05-01 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Carbohydrate conjugates as delivery agents for oligonucleotides
CA2708171C (en) 2007-12-04 2018-02-27 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Folate conjugates
CA2713379A1 (en) 2008-01-31 2009-11-05 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Optimized methods for delivery of dsrna targeting the pcsk9 gene
WO2009120878A2 (en) 2008-03-26 2009-10-01 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Non-natural ribonucleotides, and methods of use thereof
EP2274425A2 (en) 2008-04-11 2011-01-19 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals Inc. Site-specific delivery of nucleic acids by combining targeting ligands with endosomolytic components
AU2009298802A1 (en) 2008-09-23 2010-04-08 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Chemical modifications of monomers and oligonucleotides with cycloaddition
US8168775B2 (en) 2008-10-20 2012-05-01 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting expression of transthyretin
US8987435B2 (en) 2008-10-24 2015-03-24 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligomeric compounds and methods
HUE037082T2 (en) 2008-11-10 2018-08-28 Arbutus Biopharma Corp Novel lipids and compositions for the delivery of therapeutics
JP5769701B2 (en) 2009-05-05 2015-08-26 テクミラ ファーマシューティカルズ コーポレイションTekmira Pharmaceuticals Corporation Lipid composition
DK2440183T3 (en) 2009-06-10 2018-10-01 Arbutus Biopharma Corp Improved lipid formulation
WO2011038356A2 (en) 2009-09-25 2011-03-31 Johns Hopkins University Novel liver-targeting agents and their synthesis
TWI388338B (en) 2009-10-26 2013-03-11 Iner Aec Executive Yuan Method of radiolabelling multivalent glycoside for using as hepatic receptor imaging agent
TWI391144B (en) 2009-10-26 2013-04-01 Iner Aec Executive Yuan A quantification method for remaining liver function with a novel liver receptor imaging agent
WO2011072290A2 (en) 2009-12-11 2011-06-16 The Regents Of The University Of Michigan Targeted dendrimer-drug conjugates
NZ601737A (en) * 2010-02-24 2013-06-28 Arrowhead Res Corp Compositions for targeted delivery of sirna
WO2011120053A1 (en) 2010-03-26 2011-09-29 Mersana Therapeutics, Inc. Modified polymers for delivery of polynucleotides, method of manufacture, and methods of use thereof
US8865675B2 (en) * 2010-05-12 2014-10-21 Protiva Biotherapeutics, Inc. Compositions and methods for silencing apolipoprotein B
WO2011163121A1 (en) * 2010-06-21 2011-12-29 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Multifunctional copolymers for nucleic acid delivery
US9290760B2 (en) 2010-09-15 2016-03-22 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Modified iRNA agents
US8501930B2 (en) 2010-12-17 2013-08-06 Arrowhead Madison Inc. Peptide-based in vivo siRNA delivery system
EP3192800A1 (en) * 2010-12-17 2017-07-19 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Galactose cluster-pharmacokinetic modulator targeting moiety for sirna
CA2976966C (en) 2010-12-29 2021-11-09 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Small molecule conjugates for intracellular delivery of nucleic acids
CN111172162A (en) 2011-04-21 2020-05-19 葛兰素史克公司 Modulation of Hepatitis B Virus (HBV) expression
KR20140051357A (en) 2011-08-26 2014-04-30 애로우헤드 리서치 코오포레이션 Poly(vinyl ester) polymers for in vivo nucleic acid delivery
US10023861B2 (en) 2011-08-29 2018-07-17 Ionis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligomer-conjugate complexes and their use
AR090905A1 (en) 2012-05-02 2014-12-17 Merck Sharp & Dohme CONJUGATES CONTAINING TETRAGALNAC AND PEPTIDES AND PROCEDURES FOR THE ADMINISTRATION OF OLIGONUCLEOTIDES, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION
TWI595885B (en) 2012-05-02 2017-08-21 喜納製藥公司 Novel tetragalnac containing conjugates and methods for delivery of oligonucleotides
US20150299696A1 (en) 2012-05-02 2015-10-22 Sirna Therapeutics, Inc. SHORT INTERFERING NUCLEIC ACID (siNA) COMPOSITIONS
ES2947520T3 (en) 2012-08-06 2023-08-10 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals Inc Process for the preparation of carbohydrate-conjugated RNA agents
US9228184B2 (en) * 2012-09-29 2016-01-05 Dynavax Technologies Corporation Human toll-like receptor inhibitors and methods of use thereof
US20150291958A1 (en) 2012-11-15 2015-10-15 Roche Innovation Center Copenhagen A/S Anti apob antisense conjugate compounds
WO2014118272A1 (en) 2013-01-30 2014-08-07 Santaris Pharma A/S Antimir-122 oligonucleotide carbohydrate conjugates
RU2018108405A (en) 2013-01-30 2019-02-26 Ф. Хоффманн-Ля Рош Аг CARBOHYDRATE AND LNA-OLIGONUCLEOTIDE CONJUGATES
TW201446791A (en) 2013-05-01 2014-12-16 Regulus Therapeutics Inc MicroRNA compounds and methods for modulating miR-122
CA3177846A1 (en) 2013-07-11 2015-01-15 Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligonucleotide-ligand conjugates and process for their preparation
EP3065758B1 (en) 2013-11-06 2019-09-25 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Peptide containing conjugates for dual molecular delivery of oligonucleotides
JP6667453B2 (en) 2014-05-01 2020-03-18 アイオーニス ファーマシューティカルズ, インコーポレーテッドIonis Pharmaceuticals,Inc. Compositions and methods for modulating growth hormone receptor expression
WO2015188194A1 (en) 2014-06-06 2015-12-10 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions and methods for enhanced intestinal absorption of conjugated oligomeric compounds
TW201620526A (en) 2014-06-17 2016-06-16 愛羅海德研究公司 Compositions and methods for inhibiting gene expression of alpha-1 antitrypsin
CN104087574B (en) * 2014-06-23 2019-08-02 中国人民解放军海军医学研究所 A method of being used to prepare liver cell targeting transmission siRNA
US20160078088A1 (en) * 2014-09-15 2016-03-17 Rajat Venkatesh Systems and Methods for Providing Metadata Aware Background Caching in Data Analysis
KR20170068469A (en) 2014-10-10 2017-06-19 에프. 호프만-라 로슈 아게 Galnac phosphoramidites, nucleic acid conjugates thereof and their use
CN108064313B (en) 2015-03-17 2021-07-30 箭头药业股份有限公司 Compositions and methods for inhibiting gene expression of factor XII
US20160272970A1 (en) 2015-03-17 2016-09-22 Arrowhead Madison Inc. RNA Interference Agents
AU2016306275A1 (en) 2015-08-07 2018-02-08 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi therapy for Hepatitis B virus infection
JP2020505415A (en) * 2017-01-30 2020-02-20 アローヘッド ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッド Compositions and methods for inhibiting factor XII gene expression

Patent Citations (17)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9127276B2 (en) * 2013-05-01 2015-09-08 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Conjugated antisense compounds and their use
US10240153B2 (en) * 2014-07-16 2019-03-26 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Organic compositions to treat APOC3-related diseases
US11066667B2 (en) * 2014-07-16 2021-07-20 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Organic compositions to treat APOC3-related diseases
US10662427B2 (en) * 2015-10-01 2020-05-26 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting gene expression of LPA
US20200263179A1 (en) * 2015-10-01 2020-08-20 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting gene expression of lpa
US20210189394A1 (en) * 2016-03-07 2021-06-24 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting Ligands For Therapeutic Compounds
US10246709B2 (en) * 2016-03-07 2019-04-02 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting ligands for therapeutic compounds
US10294474B2 (en) * 2016-09-02 2019-05-21 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting ligands
US11174481B2 (en) * 2016-09-02 2021-11-16 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Targeting ligands
US10450565B2 (en) * 2017-01-10 2019-10-22 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Alpha-1 antitrypsin (AAT) RNAi agents, compositions including AAT RNAi agents, and methods of use
US10597657B2 (en) * 2017-09-11 2020-03-24 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of apolipoprotein C-III (APOC3)
US10995335B2 (en) * 2017-09-14 2021-05-04 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of angiopoietin-like 3 (ANGPTL3), and methods of use
US11492624B2 (en) * 2017-10-17 2022-11-08 Arrowheads Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents and compositions for inhibiting expression of Asialoglycoprotein receptor 1
US20220402947A1 (en) * 2018-02-17 2022-12-22 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Trialkyne Linking Agents and Methods of Use
US20220056454A1 (en) * 2018-09-19 2022-02-24 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi Agents for Inhibiting Expression of 17beta-HSD Type 13 (HSD17B13), Compositions Thereof, and Methods of Use
US20220152079A1 (en) * 2019-08-05 2022-05-19 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods For The Treatment Of APOC3-Related Diseases And Disorders
US20210301294A1 (en) * 2020-03-26 2021-09-30 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi Agents For Inhibiting Expression Of PNPLA3, Pharmaceutical Compositions Thereof, And Methods Of Use

Non-Patent Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
Chen et al., "Synthesis of Antisense Oligonucleotide-Peptide Conjugate Targeting to GLUT-1 in HepG-2 and MCF-7 Cells" Bioconjugate Chem vol. 13 pp. 525-529 (Year: 2002) *
Ming et al., "Bioconjugates for Targeted Delivery of Therapeutic Oligonucleotides" Adv Drug Deliv Rev vol. 87 pp. 81-89 (Year: 2015) *
Reidl et al., "Targeting the Eph System with Peptides and Peptide Conjugates" Curr Drug Targets vol. 16 no. 10 pp. 1031-1047 (Year: 2015) *
Zhu et al. "Aptamer-Drug Conjugates" Bioconjug Chem vol. 26 no. 11 pp. 2186-2197 (Year: 2015) *

Cited By (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11534453B2 (en) 2015-08-07 2022-12-27 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi therapy for hepatitis B virus infection
US11590156B2 (en) 2016-08-04 2023-02-28 Arrowhead Pharmaceuticals, Inc. RNAi agents for hepatitis B virus infection

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
IL264750B1 (en) 2023-04-01
US20180064819A1 (en) 2018-03-08
AU2017320582A1 (en) 2019-03-21
BR112019004178A2 (en) 2019-05-28
IL264750A (en) 2019-03-31
JOP20210207A1 (en) 2023-01-30
MX2023006105A (en) 2023-06-08
JOP20170056B1 (en) 2021-08-17
KR20220077157A (en) 2022-06-08
SG10201912835QA (en) 2020-02-27
CN116942841A (en) 2023-10-27
TW202320855A (en) 2023-06-01
KR102403408B1 (en) 2022-05-30
MX2018009853A (en) 2018-11-09
TWI775743B (en) 2022-09-01
SG11201901841TA (en) 2019-03-28
CA3011668A1 (en) 2018-03-08
AU2023255025A1 (en) 2023-11-16
CN109462981A (en) 2019-03-12
KR102557906B1 (en) 2023-07-20
WO2018044350A1 (en) 2018-03-08
AU2017320582B2 (en) 2023-11-16
KR20190043132A (en) 2019-04-25
JP6989521B2 (en) 2022-01-05
IL264750B2 (en) 2023-08-01
UY37145A (en) 2019-08-30
EP3506913A4 (en) 2020-06-10
IL300869A (en) 2023-04-01
JP2022028920A (en) 2022-02-16
US11174481B2 (en) 2021-11-16
US10294474B2 (en) 2019-05-21
JP2019526527A (en) 2019-09-19
CN116832169A (en) 2023-10-03
CN109462981B (en) 2023-07-07
TW201811375A (en) 2018-04-01
EP3506913A1 (en) 2019-07-10
KR20230115344A (en) 2023-08-02
MX2023006109A (en) 2023-06-08
US20190256849A1 (en) 2019-08-22

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US20220033817A1 (en) Targeting Ligands
US20210189394A1 (en) Targeting Ligands For Therapeutic Compounds
US11078227B2 (en) 5′-cyclo-phosphonate modified nucleotides
NZ785763A (en) Targeting ligands
EA043375B1 (en) TARGETTING LIGANDS
NZ785880A (en) Targeting ligands for therapeutic compounds
EA045605B1 (en) TARGETTING LIGANDS FOR THERAPEUTIC COMPOUNDS

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: ARROWHEAD PHARMACEUTICALS, INC., CALIFORNIA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:LI, ZHEN;PEI, TAO;GLEBOCKA, AGNIESZKA;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20170406 TO 20170425;REEL/FRAME:056646/0914

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER